Professional Documents
Culture Documents
Product Overview Technology Periodical Service Parts Replacement and Cleaning Adjustment Troubleshooting Error Code Service Mode Installation
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Appendix
0-2
Application
This manual has been issued by Canon Inc. for qualified persons to learn technical theory, installation, maintenance, and repair of products. This manual covers all localities where the products are sold. For this reason, there may be information in this manual that does not apply to your locality. The following paragraph does not apply to any countries where such provisions are inconsistent with local law.
Trademarks
The product names and company names used in this manual are the registered trademarks of the individual companies.
Corrections
This manual may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors due to improvements or changes in products. When changes occur in applicable products or in the contents of this manual, Canon will release technical information as the need arises. In the event of major changes in the contents of this manual over a long or short period, Canon will issue a new edition of this manual.
Copyright
This manual is copyrighted with all rights reserved. Under the copyright laws, this manual may not be copied, reproduced or translated into another language, in whole or in part, without the consent of Canon Inc.
Caution
Use of this manual should be strictly supervised to avoid disclosure of confidential information.
0-2
0-3
Explanation of Symbols
The following symbols are used throughout this Service Manual. 1. Symbols
Check.
The following rules apply throughout this Service Manual: Each chapter contains sections explaining the purpose of specific functions and the relationship between electrical and mechanical systems with reference to the timing of operation. In the diagrams, signal. represents the path of mechanical drive; where a signal name indicates the direction of the electric accompanies the symbol, the arrow
Explanation
Symbols
Explanation
Remove the claw.
Check visually.
The expression "turn on the power" means flipping on the power switch, closing the front door, and closing the delivery unit door, which results in supplying the machine with power. 2. In the digital circuits, '1' is used to indicate that the voltage level of a given signal is "High", while '0' is used to indicate "Low". (The voltage value, however, differs from circuit to circuit.) In addition, the asterisk (*) as in "DRMD*" indicates that the DRMD signal goes on when '0'. In practically all cases, the internal mechanisms of a microprocessor cannot be checked
in the field. Therefore, the operations of the microprocessors used in the machines are not discussed: they are explained in terms of from sensors to the input of the DC controller PCB and from the output of the DC controller PCB to the loads. The descriptions in this Service Manual are subject to change without notice for product improvement or other purposes, and major changes will be communicated in the form of Service Information bulletins. All service persons are expected to have a good understanding of the contents of this Service
Remove the cable/wire from the cable guide or wire saddle. Set the cable/wire to the cable guide or wire saddle.
Manual and all relevant Service Information bulletins and be able to identify and isolate faults in the machine
0-3
Blank Page
0-5
Contents
0 Safety Precautions
CDRH Act --------------------------------------------------------------------- 0-14 Laser Safety ------------------------------------------------------------------ 0-14 Handling of Laser System ------------------------------------------------ 0-14 Turn power switch ON ----------------------------------------------------- 0-15 Power Supply ---------------------------------------------------------------- 0-15 Safety of Toner --------------------------------------------------------------- 0-16 Notes When Handling the Lithium and Ni-MH Batteries ---------- 0-16 Notes Before it Works Serving ------------------------------------------- 0-16
Cross Sectional View (250-sheet 1st cassette model) ------------------ 1-11 Operation ---------------------------------------------------------------------------1-12
Power Switch -------------------------------------------------------------------------------1-12 Description of Control Panel ------------------------------------------------------------1-12
Technology
Basic Configuration -----------------------------------------------------------2-2 Original Exposure System --------------------------------------------------2-3
Functional Configuration --------------------------------------------------------- 2-2
Basic sequence ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-2
Product Overview
Product Lineup-----------------------------------------------------------------1-2
Host machine ----------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-2
Host machine configuration -------------------------------------------------------------- 1-2 Model type ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-2
Controls -----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-19
Flow of Image Data -----------------------------------------------------------------------2-19 Construction of the Image Processing Module -------------------------------------2-19 Reader Unit Input Image Processing -------------------------------------------------2-20 Compressio/ Extesion/ Editing Block -------------------------------------------------2-20
Name of Parts------------------------------------------------------------------1-9
External View ----------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-9 Cross Sectional View (550-sheet 1st cassete model) -------------------1-10
0-5
0
Printer unit Output Image Processing ------------------------------------------------2-21 Flow of Image Data According to Copy Functions --------------------------------2-21 Flow of Image Data for the SEND Function ----------------------------------------2-22 Flow of Image Data for the Fax Transmission --------------------------------------2-22 Flow of Image Data for the Fax Reception Function -----------------------------2-23 Flow of Image Data for the PDL Function -------------------------------------------2-23 Software counter ---------------------------------------------------------------------------2-24 Fan --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-24 Power supply -------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-25
0-6
Transfer Unit --------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-40 Waste Toner Box ---------------------------------------------------------------------------2-41
Overview ----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-43
Features--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-43 Specifications -------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-43 Major parts configuration ----------------------------------------------------------------2-44
Controls -----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-45
Fixing temperature control: overview -------------------------------------------------2-45 Standby temperature control------------------------------------------------------------2-46 Print temperature control ----------------------------------------------------------------2-46 Down sequence control ------------------------------------------------------------------2-48 User mode related to fixing grade -----------------------------------------------------2-50 Paper loop amount control before fixing ---------------------------------------------2-51 Protection features ------------------------------------------------------------------------2-52
Overview ----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-53
Specification --------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-53 Parts Configuration ------------------------------------------------------------------------2-53 Diagram of Paper Paths (w/ 2 Way Unit/ inaner 2 way tray)--------------------2-57 Diagram of Paper Paths (w/o 2 Way Unit) ------------------------------------------2-58
Controls -----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-60
Overview -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-60 Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st cassette model) --------------------2-60 Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette model) --------------------2-64 Multi-Purpose Pickup Assembly -------------------------------------------------------2-67 Fixing / Registration Assembly ---------------------------------------------------------2-68 Duplex / Delivery Assembly -------------------------------------------------------------2-69 Detecting Jams -----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-69
Controls -----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-37
Drum Unit ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-37 Developing Unit ----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-38 Toner Container ----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-39
0-6
0
Product Overview -----------------------------------------------------------------2-71
Overview -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-71 Features and benefits --------------------------------------------------------------------2-71
0-7
Removing the Front Cover -----------------------------------------------------4-15 Removing the Lower Left Cover ----------------------------------------------4-16 Removing the Left Cover -------------------------------------------------------4-16 Removing the Inside Base Cover ---------------------------------------------4-17 Installing the Inside Base Cover ----------------------------------------------4-18 Removing the Left Rear Cover ------------------------------------------------4-18 Removing the Toner Supply Cover -------------------------------------------4-19 Removing the Reader Right Cover -------------------------------------------4-20 Removing the Platen Glass ----------------------------------------------------4-20 Removing the Reader Rear Cover -------------------------------------------4-20 Removing the Rear Cover (Right) --------------------------------------------4-21 Removing the Rear Cover (Left) ----------------------------------------------4-22 Removing the Rear Right Cover (Upper) -----------------------------------4-22 Removing the Rear Right Cover (Lower) -----------------------------------4-22 Removing the Lower Rear Cover ---------------------------------------------4-22 Removing the Cassette 2 Rear Cover ---------------------------------------4-23
E-RDS Setup-----------------------------------------------------------------------2-72
Advance preparations --------------------------------------------------------------------2-72 Network settings ---------------------------------------------------------------------------2-72 Steps to E-RDS Settings-----------------------------------------------------------------2-75 Communication log ------------------------------------------------------------------------2-76 Initializing E-RDS settings ---------------------------------------------------------------2-76
Service cautions-------------------------------------------------------------------2-82
3 4
Periodical Service
Consumable Parts and Cleaning Parts ----------------------------------3-2
Removing the Right Cover Assembly ----------------------------------------4-24 Removing the Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st Cassette Model) -------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-26 Removing the Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette Model) -------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-27 Removing the Laser Scanner Unit--------------------------------------------4-28
Action to Take after Replacing the Laser Scanner Unit --------------------------4-29
Removing the Control Panel Assembly -------------------------------------4-34 Removing the Multi Pickup Assembly ---------------------------------------4-35
0-7
0
Removing the Separation Static Charge Eliminator----------------------4-37 Removing the Waste Toner Container ---------------------------------------4-37 Removing the Drum Unit --------------------------------------------------------4-38 Removing the Developing Assembly-----------------------------------------4-39 Removing the Manual Feed Pickup Roller ---------------------------------4-39 Removing the Manual Feed Separation Pad ------------------------------4-40 Removing the Fixing Unit -------------------------------------------------------4-41 Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller (250-sheet 1st cassette Model) --4-41 Removing the Roller Cassette Separation Pad (250-sheet 1st cassette Model) -------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-42 Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller (550-sheet 1st cassette Model) --4-42 Removing the Cassette Feed Roller (550-sheet 1st cassette Model) ----4-42 Removing the Cassette Separation Roller (550-sheet 1st cassette Model) -------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-43 Removing the Idler Gear (Only for 550-sheet 1st cassette Model for China) --------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-43
0-8
Removing the RAM PCB--------------------------------------------------------4-48
Replacement Procedure -----------------------------------------------------------------4-48
PCB----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-44
Adjustment
Outline ---------------------------------------------------------------------------5-2
Adjustment when replacing parts ---------------------------------------------- 5-2 Image position adjustment------------------------------------------------------- 5-2 Scanning System ------------------------------------------------------------------ 5-3
Action to Take after Replacing the CIS Unit------------------------------------------ 5-3 Action to Take after Replacing the Platen Glass ------------------------------------ 5-3 Action to Take after Replacing the ADF Scan Glass ------------------------------- 5-4
0-8
0
Controller System ------------------------------------------------------------------ 5-4
Action to Take after Replacing theMain Controller PCB -------------------------- 5-4 Action to Take when Replacing the DC Controller PCB -------------------------- 5-4 Action to Take after Replacing the RAM ---------------------------------------------- 5-5
0-9
Outline -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-2
Outline ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-8 User Error Code----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-8 Service Error Code ------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-9
Troubleshooting
Initial Check --------------------------------------------------------------------6-2 Test Print ------------------------------------------------------------------------6-3 Troubleshooting items -------------------------------------------------------6-4
Initial check items list ------------------------------------------------------------- 6-2
Service Mode
Outline ---------------------------------------------------------------------------8-2
Outline of Service Mode---------------------------------------------------------- 8-2 Using the Mode--------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-3 Setting of Bit Switch --------------------------------------------------------------- 8-3
Outline ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-3
Overview ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-3 Select the test print TYPE ------------------------------------------------------- 6-3 Troubleshooting items list -------------------------------------------------------- 6-4 Image Faults ------------------------------------------------------------------------ 6-4
Paper Reverse Side Stained with Toner ---------------------------------------------- 6-4 Stained Leading/Trailing Edge of Paper --------------------------------------------- 6-4 Image Transfer Wrong/Text Void-------------------------------------------------------- 6-5 Image Deletion/Blur/Dew Condensation ---------------------------------------------- 6-5 Too Large Curl ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-6 Thin Paper Jam (63g/cm2 or Less) ---------------------------------------------------- 6-6 Paper Jam due to Solid Image Printed on Paper with Small Leading-Edge Margin (1-4 mm) --------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-6 Cannot Turn the Toner Bottle Set Lever or Hard to Turn it ----------------------- 6-6 Abnormal Noise During Multi-Feed Peration --------------------------------------- 6-7
#MENU ------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-13
Menu Switch Composition ---------------------------------------------------------------8-13 Deatails---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-13
#NUMERIC -------------------------------------------------------------------------8-14
Numerical Parameter Composition----------------------------------------------------8-14 Details ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-15
#SCAN-------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-19
Setting of Scanner Functions (SCANNER) -----------------------------------------8-19 Numeric Parameter Settings (Numeric Prama.) -----------------------------------8-21 READER -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-22
Error Code
Overview ------------------------------------------------------------------------7-2
#PRINT ------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-26
0-9
0
Numerin Parameter Settings (Numeric Prama). -----------------------------------8-26 Service Soft Switch Settings (PRINTER) --------------------------------------------8-27 List of Functions----------------------------------------------------------------------------8-28 List of Functions(PRINT CST) ----------------------------------------------------------8-31
0-10
#TEST MODE ---------------------------------------------------------------------8-46
Outline ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-46 Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-46 Details ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-47
#NETWORK------------------------------------------------------------------------8-33
Confirmation of contents of CA certificate -------------------------------------------8-33
#CODEC ----------------------------------------------------------------------------8-33
Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-33 Details ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-33
Installation
How to check this Installation Procedure -------------------------------9-2
When Using the parts included in the package ---------------------------- 9-2 Symbols in the Illustration ------------------------------------------------------- 9-2
#SYSTEM---------------------------------------------------------------------------8-33
Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-33 Details of Bit Switch -----------------------------------------------------------------------8-33 Details of System Numeric --------------------------------------------------------------8-34
Making Pre-Checks-----------------------------------------------------------9-2
#ACC---------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-34
Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-34
#COUNTER ------------------------------------------------------------------------8-35
Counters -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-35 Clearing Counters -------------------------------------------------------------------------8-35
Points to Make Before Installation ----------------------------------------9-3 Option Installation Sequence ----------------------------------------------9-3 Checking the Contents ------------------------------------------------------9-4 Unpacking and Installation Procedure -----------------------------------9-6
Unpacking the Machine and Removing the Packaging Materials ----- 9-6 Installing the Toner Bottle -------------------------------------------------------- 9-8 Installing the Drum Unit ---------------------------------------------------------- 9-9 Connecting the cord -------------------------------------------------------------- 9-11 Stirring Toner -----------------------------------------------------------------------9-12 Installing Trays---------------------------------------------------------------------9-12 Setting the Cassettes ------------------------------------------------------------9-13 Installing Other Parts-------------------------------------------------------------9-14 Checking the Print Image ------------------------------------------------------9-17 Checking the Connection to the Network -----------------------------------9-17 Setting the Date and Time ------------------------------------------------------9-17 Setting the Cassette Heater (if equipped with the cassette heater) --9-17
#LMS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-36
Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-36 Outline ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-36 Details ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-36 Method of confirming license option --------------------------------------------------8-37 Inactivity of the transmitted license----------------------------------------------------8-37 Erasing a License--------------------------------------------------------------------------8-38
#E-RDS------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-39
Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-39
#REPORT---------------------------------------------------------------------------8-40
Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-40 Details ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-40
#DOWNLOAD ---------------------------------------------------------------------8-44
Download ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-44
#CLEAR -----------------------------------------------------------------------------8-45
Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-45
#DISPLAY---------------------------------------------------------------------------8-45
Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-45
#ROM --------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-46
Configuration--------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-46
0-10
0
Checking the Contents ----------------------------------------------------------9-21 Points to Note Before Installation ---------------------------------------------9-22
Turning Main Power OFF ---------------------------------------------------------------9-22
0-11
Installation Procedure------------------------------------------------------------9-53
Installation of Reader Harness ---------------------------------------------------------9-53 Removal of Parts from Reader ---------------------------------------------------------9-56 Installation of Reader Heater (for iR2530/2525/2520 series)-------------------9-56 Installation of Reader Heater (for iR2545/2535 series) --------------------------9-57
Installation Procedure-------------------------------------------------------------- 31
Installation Procedure------------------------------------------------------------9-35
Installation Procedure------------------------------------------------------------9-76
Installation Procedure------------------------------------------------------------9-39
Appendix
Service Tools ----------------------------------------------------------------- 9-88
Special Tools --------------------------------------------------------------------------------9-88 Oils and Solvents --------------------------------------------------------------------------9-88
Installation Procedure------------------------------------------------------------9-45
0-11
0
General Circuit Diagram (250-sheet 1st cassette type) -----------------9-97
General Circuit Diagram (1/7) ----------------------------------------------------------9-97 General Circuit Diagram (2/7) ----------------------------------------------------------9-98 General Circuit Diagram (3/7) ----------------------------------------------------------9-99 General Circuit Diagram (4/7) -------------------------------------------------------- 9-100 General Circuit Diagram (5/7) -------------------------------------------------------- 9-101 General Circuit Diagram (6/7) -------------------------------------------------------- 9-102 General Circuit Diagram (7/7) -------------------------------------------------------- 9-103
0-12
0-12
Safety Precautions
CDRH Act Laser Safety Handling of Laser System Turn power switch ON Points to Note About Turning Off the Main Power Switch Safety of Toner Notes When Handling a Lithium Battery Notes Before it Works Serving
0-14
CDRH Act
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health of the US Food and Drum Administration put into force regulations concerning laser products on August 2, 1976. These regulations apply to laser products manufactured on and after August 1, 1976, and the sale of laser products not certified under the regulations is banned within the Untied States. The label shown here indicates compliance with the CDRH regulations, and its attachment is required on all laser products that are soled in the United States.
CANON INC.
30-2,SHIMOMARUKO,3-CHOME,OHTA-KU,TOKYO,JAPAN
MANUFACTURED:
THIS PRODUCT CONHORMS WITH DHHS RADIATION PERFORMANCE STANDARD 21CFR CHAPTER 1 SUBCHAPTER J.
F-0-1
F-0-2
Laser Safety
When servicing the area around the laser assembly, be sure to turn off the main power. The machine's covers that can reflect laser light are identified by means of a warning label (Figure). If you must detach a cover showing the label, be sure to take extra caution during the work.
0-14
0-15
Power Supply
1. As a general rule, do not use extension cords. Using an extension cord may result in a fire or electrical shock. If an extension cord must be used, however, use one for local rated voltage and over, untie the cord binding, and insert the power plug completely into the extension cord outlet to ensure a firm connection between the power cord and the extension cord. 2. The socket-outlet shall be installed near the equipment and shall be easily accessible.
F-0-3
F-0-4
0-15
0-16
Safety of Toner
About Toner
The machine's toner is a non-toxic material made of plastic, iron, and small amounts of dye.
At servicing, be sure to turn OFF the power source according to the specified steps and disconnect the power plug.
RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY IS REPLACED BY AN INCORRECT TYPE. DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO THE INSTRUCTIONS.
The following warnings are given to comply with Safety Principles (EN60950).
Wenn mit dem falschen Typ ausgewechselt, besteht Explosionsgefahr. Gebrauchte Batterien gem der Anleitung beseitigen.
0-16
Product Overview
Product Lineup Feature Specifications Name of Parts
Product Overview
Product Overview > Product Lineup > Host machine > Model type
Product Lineup
Host machine
Model type
imageRUNNER 2530 Print Speed Positioning imageRUNNER 2525 imageRUNNER 2520
20ppm
T-1-2
imageRUNNER 2530 / 2525 / 2520 Underlined (2-digit) numeric figures indicate print speed (ppm: print per minute).
F-1-2
F-1-1
Product Overview > Product Lineup > Host machine > Model type
1-2
Product Overview > Product Lineup > Option > Pickup delivery / image reading options
1-3
No.
1 2 3 4 5
Option
Pickup delivery / image reading options
[23] [7] [3] [8]
Product name
imageRUNNER 2530i/2530/2525i/2525/2520i/2520 imageRUNNER 2530i/2530/2525i/2525 DADF-AB1 Inner Finisher Additional Tray-B1 Inner Finisher-B1
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Reader Heater Unit-H1 Platen Cover Type P Document Tray-J1 FL Cassette-AJ1 FL Cassette-AK1 FL Cassette-AL1 Cassette Heater Unit-37 Cassette Module-W1
Built-in finisher Power Supply Unit-U1 is required. Cst Heater Kit-J1 is required.
[19]
14
Cst Heater Kit-J1 is required. Cassette Spacer-A1 is required when installing to 250 Sheets Cassette Model. Cassette Spacer-A1 is required when installing to 250 Sheets Cassette Model.
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
Envelope Feeder Attachment-D1 Cassette Spacer-A1 Inner 2Way Tray-G1 Cst Heater Kit-J1 Drum Heater-C1 Power Supply Unit-U1 ADF Access Handle-A1 2 Way Unit-B1 Stamp Unit-B1
For host machine delivery additional tray. Cst Heater Kit-J1 is required.
T-1-3
Product Overview > Product Lineup > Option > Pickup delivery / image reading options
1-3
Product Overview > Product Lineup > Option > Function expanding option
1-4
No. Product name
Card Reader-E1 Card Reader Attachment-D3 Super G3 Fax Board-AG1 USB Application 3-Port Interface Kit-A1 Serial Interface Kit-J2 System Upgrade RAM-C1 System Upgrade SD Card-A1 Copy Control Interface Cable-A1 Barcode Printing Kit-B1 PCL Printer Kit-AF1 PS Printer Kit-AF1 Color Send Kit-Y1 Color Send Searchable PDF Kit-C1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
PCL Printer Kit-AF1 is required. 512MB RAM should be installed. In the case of 256MB, System Upgrade RAM-C1 (512MB) is needed.
T-1-4
[3]
F-1-4
Product Overview > Product Lineup > Option > Function expanding option
1-4
1-5
Feature
Product feature
Waste toner container - User replaceable Low running cost Developing unit - Highly-durable OPC drum is adopted. High image quality Low running cost
F-1-5
1-5
1-6
Item Paper type (Manual feed pickup tray) Specifications
Weight: 64 g/m2 to 128 g/m2 Type: Plain, Recycled, Color (64 g/m2 to 80 g/m2), 3-hole punch, Bond (75 g/m2 to 90 g/m2), Heavy Paper 1 (81 g/m2 to 90 g/ m2), Heavy Paper 2 (91 g/m2 to 105 g/m2), Heavy Paper 3 (106 g/m2 to 128 g/m2), Transparencies, Labels, Envelopes (No.10 (COM10), ISO-B5, Monarch, ISO-C5, DL) Standard size (A4, A4R, A3, A5R, B4, B5, B5R, LTR, LTTR, LG, 11" x 17", STMTR) Standard size (A4, A4R, A3, A5R, B4, B5, B5R, LTR, LTTR, LG, 11"" x 17"", STMTR) Envelopes* (No.10 (COM10), ISO-B5, Monarch, ISO-C5, DL) * The optional Envelope Feeder Attachment-D1 is required. Standard size (A4, A4R, A3, A5R, B4, B5, B5R, LTR, LTTR, LG, 11"" x 17"", STMTR) Free size (99 mm x 297 mm to 148 mm x 432 mm) Envelopes (No.10 (COM10), ISO-B5, Monarch, ISO-C5, DL) 550 sheets cassette: 550 sheets (80g/m2) 550 sheets cassette: 250 sheets (80g/m2) Manual feed pickup tray: 100 sheets (80g/m2) Through path duplex imageRUNNER 2530i/2530: operation: 69.50 dB or less *1 / stand-by: 43.00 dB or less *2 imageRUNNER 2525i/2525: operation: 67.75 dB or less *1 / stand-by: 43.00 dB or less *2 imageRUNNER 2520i/2520: operation: 66.00 dB or less / stand-by: 43.00dB or less *2 *1 Except for china model. China model: 66.00 dB or less (operation) *2 Except for china model. China model: 43.00 dB or less (standby) Max: 0.035 ppm or less imageRUNNER 2530/2525 (US): 120 - 127 V AC, 50Hz/60Hz, 6.9 A imageRUNNER 2520 (US): 120 - 127 V AC, 50Hz/60Hz, 6.2 A imageRUNNER 2530i/2530/2525i/2525/2520i/2520 (Except US): 220 - 240 V AC, 50Hz/60Hz, 3.3 A 120 - 127 V model: Approx. 1.473 kW 220 - 240 V model: Approx. 1.542 kW
Specifications
Specifications
Item Copyboard Body Light source type Photosensitive medium Image reading method Reproduction method Exposure method Charging method Development method Transfer method Separation method Pickup method Specifications
Stream reading, original fixed reading Desktop LED (RGB) OPC drum (30 mm dia) CIS Indirect electrostatic method Laser exposure system Roller charge Dry single component projection developing By transfer roller Curvature and static eliminator 550 sheets cassette: Retard separation method 250 sheets cassette: Pad separation method Manual feed pickup tray: Pad separation method On demand Fixing method Face down delivery (in-body delivery) Delivery method 25% to 400% Reproduction ratio By cleaning blade Drum cleaning method Magnetic negative charge toner Toner type Toner cartridge Toner replenish method Yes Toner level detection function 2.5 -/+ 1.5 mm Top margin 2.5 -/+ 1.5 mm Left margin Non-image width (leading edge) 2.5 -/+ 1.5 mm 2.5 -/+ 1.5 mm Non-image width (left edge) * Using the feeder: 2.5 -/+ 2.0 mm At power ON: 30 sec or less Warm-up time 256 gradations Number of gradations 600 dpi x 600 dpi Reading resolution 1200 dpi x 1200 dpi Writing resolution imageRUNNER 2530i/2530/2525i/2525: 5.4 sec or less First print time imageRUNNER 2520i/2520: 6.4 sec or less Weight: 64 g/m2 to 90 g/m2 Paper type (Cassette 1/3/4) Type: Plain, Recycled, Color (64 g/m2 to 80 g/m2), 3-hole punch Weight: 64 g/m2 to 90 g/m2 Paper type (Cassette 2) Type: Plain, Recycled, Color (64 g/m2 to 80 g/m2), 3-hole punch, Envelopes* (No.10 (COM10), ISO-B5, Monarch, ISO-C5, DL) * The optional Envelope Feeder Attachment-D1 is required.
Paper size (Manual feed pickup tray) Pickup capacity Duplex method Acoustic noise
1-6
1-7
Specifications
Item Dimensions (W x D x H)
Weight
imageRUNNER 2530i/2530/2525i/2525: 565mm x 680mm x 806mm (with the platen cover) 565mm x 693mm x 896mm (with the feeder) imageRUNNER 2520i/2520: 565mm 680mm 681mm (with the platen cover and single cassette) 565mm 693mm 771mm (with the feeder and single cassette) 565mm 680mm 806mm (with the platen cover and double cassette) 565mm 693mm 896mm (with the feeder and double cassette) Max (with the feeder, double cassette and 2 way unit): Approx. 77.5 kg Min with the platen cover and single cassette): Approx. 50.5 kg
T-1-5
Weight / Size
Product name imageRUNNER 2530i/2530/2525i/2525 (with the platen cover) imageRUNNER 2530i/2530/2525i/2525 (with the feeder) imageRUNNER 2520i/2520 (with the platen cover) imageRUNNER 2520i/2520 (with the feeder) DADF-AB1 Inner Finisher-B1 2 Way Unit-B1 Cassette Module-W1 CST. Feeding Unit-AE1 Inner 2Way Tray-G1 Card Reader-E1 Width (mm)
565 565
Depth (mm)
680 693
Height (mm)
806 896
565 565
680 693
681 771
1-7
1-8
Paper type
For free size paper, refer to the table below. Type
Free size
Pickup
Usable paper types are shown. Paper type (g/m2) Size Manual feed pickup tray Cassette Cassette 2 Cassette Cassette with the without 1 3 4 envelope the feeder envelope feeder
A4
Plain paper Heavy Paper Plain 2-sided (with the 2 paper way unit) Heavy Paper Plain 2-sided paper (without Heavy the 2 way Paper
1-sided
A3
unit) 1-sided
Plain paper Heavy Paper Plain 2-sided (with the 2 paper way unit) Heavy Paper Plain 2-sided paper (without the 2 way Heavy Paper
- Plain (64 to 90) - Color (64 to 90) - Recycled (64 to 90) - Bond (75 to 90)
unit)
A4, A4R, A3, A5R, B4, B5, B5R, LTR, LTTR, LGL, 11" x 17", STMTR - Heavy Paper A4, A4R, A3, (91 to 128)" A5R, B4, B5, B5R, LTR, LTTR, LGL, 11" x 17", STMTR - Labels A4, B4, LTR - Transparencies A4, LTR - 3-hole punch LTR - Envelopes No.10 (COM10), ISO-B5, Monarch, ISO-C5, DL - Free size 99 mm x 297 mm to 148 mm x 432 mm
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
No No Yes
No No Yes
No No Yes
No No Yes
No No Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
No
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
T-1-9
1-8
1-9
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] Reader left cover DADF (standard or optional) Reader front cover Control panel Support cover Delivery tray Front cover Cassette 1 Cassette 2 (standard or optional) Cassette 3 (option) Cassette 4 (option) Lower left cover Left cover Inside base cover [15] [16] [17] [18] [19] [20] [21] [22] [23] [24] [25] [26] [27] [28] Rear left cover Toner supply cover Reader right cover Platen glass Reader rear cover Rear cover (right) Rear cover (left) Right cover (upper rear) Right cover (lower rear) Manual feed pickup tray Right cover Lower rear cover Cassette 2 rear cover Main power switch
Name of Parts
External View
[2] [1] [3] [4] [17] [18] [19]
[5] [6] [15] [16] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [28]
[25]
[21] [20]
[14] [13]
[26] [27]
F-1-6
1-9
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Cross Sectional View (550-sheet 1st cassete model)
1-10
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] CIS unit ADF reading glass Platen glass Toner bottle Drum unit Drum cleaning unit Delivery roller 2 way unit Fixing outlet roller Fixing film unit Pressure roller Duplex feed roller 1 Photosensitive drum Duplex feed roller 2 Transfer roller [16] [17] [18] [19] [20] [21] [22] [23] [24] [25] [26] [27] [28] [29] Registration roller Manual feed pickup roller Pickup roller (cassette 1) Vertical path roller 1 Feed roller (cassette 1) Separation roller (cassette 1) Vertical path roller 2 Feed roller (cassette 2) Separation roller (cassette 2) Pickup roller (cassette 2) Primary charging roller Developing unit Sub hopper Laser scanner unit
[8]
[9]
[10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16] [17] [18] [19] [20] [21] [22] [23] [24] [25]
[29]
[28]
[27]
[26]
F-1-7
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Cross Sectional View (550-sheet 1st cassete model)
1-10
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Cross Sectional View (250-sheet 1st cassette model)
1-11
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] CIS unit ADF reading glass Platen glass Toner bottle Drum unit Drum cleaning unit Delivery roller 2 way unit Fixing outlet roller Fixing film unit Pressure roller Duplex feed roller 1 Photosensitive drum Duplex feed roller 2 [15] [16] [17] [18] [19] [20] [21] [22] [23] [24] [25] [26] [27] Transfer roller Registration roller Manual feed pickup roller Pickup roller (cassette 1) Vertical path roller 1 Vertical path roller 2 Feed roller (cassette 2) Separation roller (cassette 2) Pickup roller (cassette 2) Primary charging roller Developing unit Sub hopper Laser scanner unit
[8]
[9]
[19] [18]
[27]
[26]
[25]
[24]
F-1-8
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Cross Sectional View (250-sheet 1st cassette model)
1-11
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Operation > Description of Control Panel
Operation
Power Switch
Types of power switch
Control panel power switch
[18] [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] Touch panel display Display Contrast dial COPY key SEND key SCAN/OPTIONS key Control Panel Power Switch (Sub Power Supply) Additional Function key Volume Control key Counter Check key
[17] [16] [15] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16] [17] [18]
F-1-9
This machine is equipped with the Main Power Switch and Control Panel Power Switch. [1] Main Power Switch This switch is used to turn OFF / ON the power of host machine. [2] Control Panel Power Switch This switch is to shift the machine to power-save mode or to restore it to normal mode.
Stop key Start key Main Power Indicator Error Indicator Processing/Data Indicator Clear key Log in/Out key Numeric keys Reset key
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Operation > Description of Control Panel
1-12
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Operation > Description of Control Panel
1-13
Difference of Settings / Registration menu
imageRUNNER 2030/2025/2022/2018 Series
Common Settings Timer Settings Adjustment/Cleaning Report Settings System Settings Copy Settings Communications Settings Printer Settings Address Book Settings
Main Menu
Functions
Copy Send or Fax Remote Scan System Monitor
Key
COPY key SEND key SCAN/OPTIONS key [System Monitor]
Location
Control Panel Touch Panel Display
T-1-10
* The Send function is available only when the Color Send Kit-Y1 is activated. * The Fax function is available only when the Super G3 Fax Board-AG1 is activated.
F-1-11
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Operation > Description of Control Panel
1-13
Technology
Basic Configuration Original Expusure System Controller System Laser Exposure System Image Formation System Fixing System Pickup Feed System E-RDS
Technology
Technology > Basic Configuration > Functional Configuration > Basic sequence
Basic Configuration
Functional Configuration
The machine may broadly be divided into the following functional system blocks; document exposure system block, controller system block, laser exposure system block, image formation system block, fixing system block and pickup/feed system block.
Scanner motor
Backwarding Forwarding
Document exposure system Reader relay PCB Controller system Option board Main controller DC controller Fixing system Laser exposure system Laser scanner unit Transfer Image formation system Delivery Duplexing feed CIS Exposure lamp
Shading position
F-2-2
Print sequence
Reader (Book mode, 1 original)
Fixing
Black shading/White shading Start key ON STBY SCFW
Forwarding Light-ON ON
SCRW
Backwarding Forwarding
STBY
Scanner motor
Backwarding
Pickup
ON
Cassette 1
Pickup/feed system
Shading position
Shading position
F-2-3
Cassette 2
F-2-1
Technology > Basic Configuration > Functional Configuration > Basic sequence
2-2
Technology > Original Exposure System > Construction > Major Components
M31 H5 S34
S33
Main scanning Image is processed on main controller PCB direction Sub scanning In book mode: speed change by carriage travel, image process on main controller PCB *1 direction Lens CMOS sensor CIS drive control Original size In book mode detection In ADF mode
In ADF mode: original feed speed change, image process on main controller PCB *1 Rod lens array Number of lines:1 Number of pixels: Total 7488 (incl. 7276 effective pixels) Maximum original scan width: 297mm Drive control by reader motor (M31) Main scanning direction: by reflection sensor (AB/INCH) Sub scanning direction: by reflection sensor (AB/INCH) Main scanning direction: by photo interrupter on DADF Sub scanning direction: by photo interrupter on DADF
T-2-1 *1 Controls differ depending on magnifications. Refer to [Magnifications] for more information.
CIS
F-2-4
Item
Scanner motor CIS HP sensor Copyboard Cover Open/Closed Sensor 0 Copyboard Cover Open/Closed Sensor 1 Original Size Sensor 0 Original Size Sensor 1 Original Size Sensor 2A Original Size Sensor 2B Original Size Sensor 3 CIS unit Reader Heater Reader relay PCB
Notation
M31 S31 S32 S33
Specification/function
Pulse motor: controls the carriage drive Detects CIS home position Ends original size identification with the copy board cover at 5 deg Detects the copyboard cover open/close. Starts original size identification with the copy board cover at 30 deg. Helps identify original size (AB, INCH/AB/K, INCH/A) Helps identify original size (AB, INCH/AB/K, A) Helps identify original size (AB, INCH/AB/K, A) Helps identify original size (INCH/A) Helps identify original size (AB, INCH/AB/K, INCH/A, A) Indirect exposure by LED (LED & photoconductive body) Prevents condensation on the copyboard glass Controls the reader unit drive and image process
T-2-2
Technology > Original Exposure System > Construction > Major Components
2-3
Technology > Original Exposure System > Construction > Reader relay PCB
2-4
J554 J555
J552
J551
J558
J556 J563
J557
F-2-5
Jack No
J551 J552 J553 J554 J555 J556 J557 J558 J559 J560 J561 J562 J563
Description
Receives power from the machine (printer unit) Communication with main controller PCB Communication with main controller PCB Communication with main controller PCB Connection to copyboard cover open/close sensor Connected to the contact image sensor (CIS) HP sensor. Connection to original size sensor (2A/2B/3) Connected to the contact image sensor (CIS) sensor. Connection to Scanner motor Power supply to DADF Communication with DADF Communication with DADF Connection to original size sensor (0/1)
T-2-3
Technology > Original Exposure System > Construction > Reader relay PCB
2-4
Technology > Original Exposure System > Basic Sequence > Basic Sequence at Start Key ON (book mode/1 original)
2-5
Black shading/White shading
Basic Sequence
Basic Sequence at Power-On
Main power switch ON SREADY STBY
F-2-8
F-2-6
CISHP sensor
CISHP sensor
HP
Shading position
Shading position
1. Moves to the start position after black shading/white shading. 2. Original scan 3. Moves to the standby position
F-2-7
F-2-9
Technology > Original Exposure System > Basic Sequence > Basic Sequence at Start Key ON (book mode/1 original)
2-5
Technology > Original Exposure System > Basic Sequence > Basic Sequence at Start Key ON (ADF mode/1 original)
2-6
F-2-10
HP
Shading position
F-2-11
Technology > Original Exposure System > Basic Sequence > Basic Sequence at Start Key ON (ADF mode/1 original)
2-6
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Controlling the Scanner Drive System
2-7
Scanner Motor Control
Scanner motor driver turns on/off the motor and controls its direction/speed of rotation according to the signals from CPU.
Controls
Controlling the Scanner Drive System
Overview
Parts configuration of scanner drive is described below.
Scanner motor (M31) Reader relay PCB (PCB2)
RTP3APWN
RTP3BPWN
IC2
Original glass cover open/close sensor (rear) (S33)
Motor driver
B* B A A*
M31
F-2-13
MEMO: The scan speed of this machine is as follows: Copy (100%): 123 mm/sec Color send (300 dpi x 300 dpi): 123 mm/sec or 61.5 mm/sec
Original glass cover open/close sensor (front) (S32) CISHP sensor (S31)
- Scanner motor (M31) drive signal Turns on/off the motor and controls its direction/speed of rotation. - Contact image sensor (CIS) HP sensor (S31) signal Detects that the contact image sensor (CIS) is at the home position. - Copyboard cover open/closed sensor (front: S32/rear: S33) detection signal Detects the open/close status of the copyboard cover
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Controlling the Scanner Drive System
2-7
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Contact Image Sensor (CIS)
1) Forward Movement during Image Scan During image scan, operation of the contact image sensor (CIS) is controlled by controlling the motor as shown below.
Start position Acceleration Leading edge of original Constant speed Trailing edge Stop of original Deceleration
Light guide
LED (R/G/B)
Movement distance
[1] Acceleration area: The motor accelerates to the speed specified for each mode. [2] Runup area: A margin to stabilize the speed. [3] Image read area: The image is read at a constant speed. [4] Deceleration area: Upon detection of the trailing edge, the motor decelerates rapidly and stops.
Original glass
2) Backward Movement after Image Scan position at the constant speed (123 mm/sec).
F-2-14
After image scan, the carriage moves back to the contact image sensor (CIS) shading
CMOS sensor array Light guide Rod lens array Light guide
LED CCD
Component
LED Light guide Rod lens array CMOS sensor array
Function
Illuminates the original. Illuminates the entire image line with the LED light. Collects the light reflected by the original. Receives the light that passed through the rod lens array.
F-2-15
T-2-4
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Contact Image Sensor (CIS)
2-8
2-9 Enlargement/Reduction
Magnification Change in Vertical Scan Direction
In the Book mode or when the ADF is used In the vertical scan direction, the image is read at 100%. Magnification is changed by processing data on the main controller PCB.
88
pi
xe l
2 ci rc ui t D riv er
74
xe l
18
2) When magnification is increased to 100-200% The original scan speed (in the Book mode)/original feed speed (when the ADF is used) is changed within the range of 123 mm/sec to 61.5 mm/sec depending on the selected magnification rate. Data is not processed on the main controller PCB.
72
pi
F-2-16
2-9
2
Overview
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Detecting the Size of Originals
2-10
AB-Configration Horizontal scan direction
Upper left corner of original Index plate
LGL
11"17" F-2-17
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Detecting the Size of Originals
2-10
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Detecting the Size of Originals
2-11
4) The copyboard cover is closed (at an angle of more than 5 deg but less than 30 deg) Original sensor: Turns on and original size identification process 2 is performed.
Original sensor 3 Original sensor 2A 5 Original (A4R) Original sensor 0
5) The original cover is closed (at an angle of 5 deg or less) The original size is identified. Original sensor: Turns off. In identifying the original size, the data obtained in the original size identification process 1 is compared with the data obtained in the original size identification process 2 to check whether these two pieces of data are identical. Note that a wrong original size may be identified because the sensor output level does not change in the following cases: - When the original is A3-sized black - When the original is a book (its thickness does not allow the copyboard cover to close fully, making it difficult to detect the sensor level change).
F-2-19
2) The copyboard cover opens (at an angle of more than 30 deg). Original sensor: Turns off.
- When the copyboard cover is not closed fully (the sensor level change is not detected after lapse of the above time-out time)
Original sensor 3 Original sensor 2A Original (A4R) Original sensor 0 Original sensor 1 Change absent Change present F-2-22
3) The copyboard cover is closed (at an angle of 30 deg). Original sensor: Turns on and original size identification process 1 is performed.
Original sensor 3 Original sensor 2A 30 Original (A4R) Original sensor 0 Original sensor 1 Original sensor 2A/3 Original sensor 0/1 F-2-20
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Detecting the Size of Originals
2-11
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Dirt Sensor Control
Before original size identification processes 1 and 2 are performed, the original size is detected with original sensors as follows:
AB-Configration
Original Original Original Original Original sensor 0 sensor 1 sensor 2A sensor 3 size A3 A4 B4(8K)*1 B5(16K)*1 A4R B5R(16K)*1 No original :No original :Change absent
Inch-Configration
Original Original Original Original size sensor 0 sensor 2B sensor 3 11"X17" LTR LGL LTR-R No original
WMUPR
*1:For Chinese paper, the following sizes are detected: 8K:Equivalent to B4 size 16K:Equivalent to B5 size
1st SCAN
2nd SCAN
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Dirt Sensor Control
2-12
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Dirt Sensor Control
2-13
- Immediately before scanning (one sheet at a time) The contact image sensor (CIS) does not move to detect dust. The original is read at the position determined at job end or start. If presence of dust is detected there, the read image is corrected. Point
A B C
[Description of Control] - At job end (Dust detection) The contact image sensor (CIS) checks the light reflected by the ADF platen roller surface at the read position for presence/absence of dust. After completion of a job,dust detection is performed in the positions A, B and C without concern of presence/absence of dust. 1) Dust detection is performed once at position A. 2) CIS moves to the position B and dust detection is performed once. 3) CIS moves to the position C and dust detection is performed once. 4-a) CIS moves to the position where there is no dust, with priority for the detecting position; A>B>C. 4-b) If dust is detected at all points A, B, and C, move back to position A and the original is scanned at position A.
Description
Read reference position About 0.5 mm from the reference position to the inside of the roller About 1.0 mm from the reference position to the inside of the roller
T-2-5
F-2-25
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Dirt Sensor Control
2-13
2
Overview
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Image Processing
2-14
Functions of the image processing system are summarized below. - Reader relay PCB: CMOS sensor drive, analog image processing, A/D, conversion, and shading correction The reader relay PCB is used to process images on a line-by-line basis. Its major functions are as follows: 1)Analog image processing - CMOS sensor drive - CMOS sensor output gain correction and offset correction - CMOS sensor output A/D conversion 2)Digital image processing - Shading correction
Image Processing
Major specifications and functions of the image processing system are as follows:
- CMOS (image sensor) Number of lines: 1 Number of pixels: Total 7488 (incl. 7176 effective pixels) Pixel size: 32 x 46.9 um Shading correction: Made for each job. Shading adjustment: Made in the Service mode.
- Shading correction
Reader relay PCB Analog image processor Analog image processing Digital image processor Shading processing Controller
A/D conversion
F-2-26
Reader relay PCB Analog image signal CMOS sensor Gain correction drive control data RAM IC2 CMOS sensor control signal
A/D conversion
J554
Shading correction
F-2-27
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Image Processing
2-14
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Image Processing
2-15
Shading Correction (Outline)
The CMOS sensor outputs are necessary even for the following reasons even when the density of the original is uniform: (1) Variation in sensitivity among CMOS sensor pixels (2) Variation in light intensity of rod lens array The machine performs shading correction to even out the CMOS sensor output. There are two types of shading correction: shading adjustment performed in the Service mode and shading correction performed for each job.
CMOS sensor 4
CMOS sensor 3
CMOS sensor 1
Shading Adjustment
The machine measures the density of the standard white plate, and stores the measured density data. It then processes the stored data to use it as the target value for shading correction.
Shading Correction
The machine performs shading correction for each scan. It measures the density of the standard white plate, and compares the measured value with the target value stored in the shading correction circuit to use the difference between the two as the shading correction
output L L H H L H L H H H L
value. The machine uses this shading correction value to correct the variation among CMOS sensor pixels when scanning the original, thus evening out the image density level.
CMOS sensor output Target value Measurement value
The analog video signals output from the CMOS sensor are corrected so that they will have a specific gain level (gain correction), and the output voltages generated in the absence of incident light are also corrected so that they it will have a specific offset level (offset correction).
White
Technology > Original Exposure System > Controls > Image Processing
2-15
Technology > Original Exposure System > Service Operations > Service precautions
2-16
Service Operations
Action to take when replacing parts
Part name Contact image sensor (CIS) Platen glass Action Reference
CIS white level automatic adjustment Refer to page Platen board cover white level automatic adjustment 5-3 ADF white level adjustment (This action is applicable only when the DFDA is installed in the host machine.) White plate data adjustment Refer to page Platen board cover white level automatic adjustment 5-3 ADF white level adjustment (This action is applicable only when the DFDA is installed in the host machine.) Platen board cover white level automatic adjustment Refer to page ADF white level adjustment 5-4
T-2-6
Consumables
None.
Service precautions
None.
Technology > Original Exposure System > Service Operations > Service precautions
2-16
2-17
Item Main controller PCB Details
System control/memory control/printer unit output image processing control, reader unit input image processing, card reader interface, image processing for FAX, USB extension hub interface Temporary saving of image data. Capacity: 256MB (maximum 512 MB ) Stores system software. Boot ROM: 16 MB Program ROM: 128 MB Stores user data / service data information USB2.0 device I/F, USB2.0 host I/F Ethernet I/F SD I/F Installed only in the machine supporting the FAX or the SEND function. Secondary battery used for image backup in case of power failure (It lasts one hour when charged for two hours.)
T-2-7
Controller System
Overview
Functional Configuration
Secondary battery
F-2-30
2-17
2-18
Connector No.
J8140 J8142
Function
Serial interface connector Laser scanner unit connector Laser scanner unit connector Pseudo CI connector NCU board connector Modem board connector Speaker connector USB (Host) connector USB hub kit connection Reader connector Lithium battery for RTC Life: About 10 years Used to turn off the power when replacing the SODIMM.
T-2-8
J8143 J8146 J8147 J8148 J8111 J8104 J8149 J8150 J8151 BAT1
BAT1 SW3
J8150 J8118
SW3
J8143 J8148 J8115 J8146 J8116 J8134 J8125 J8127 J8147 J8119 J8117
J8112
J8140 J8124
J8149
F-2-31
Connector No.
J309 J8104 J8106 J8109 J8110 J8111 J8112 J8114 J8115 J8116 J8117 J8118 J8119 J8124 J8125 J8127 J8134 Reader connector USB port (device) SO-DIMM slot
Function
ROM board slot (for market-related measures) SD card connector LAN connector DC controller PCB connector Control panel connector SOFT counter board connector SOFT ID board connector Control card connector Serial interface connector Card reader connector Secondary battery unit connector Power supply connector NCU board connector Pseudo CI connector
2-18
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Construction of the Image Processing Module
Controls
Flow of Image Data
Other iR machine Original
A
Copy Scan
A
Print output
A
Image data
Printer unit output image processing block Processes image data for output to the printer unit.
PC
F-2-32 F-2-33
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Construction of the Image Processing Module
2-19
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Compressio/ Extesion/ Editing Block
Edge emphasis
Integration
To compression/expansion/editing block
F-2-34
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Compressio/ Extesion/ Editing Block
2-20
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Flow of Image Data According to Copy Functions
2-21
Enlargement/reduction Data rotation Smoothing Data compression Data expansion To DC controller PCB
F-2-36
SO-DIMM
DC controller PCB
F-2-37
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Flow of Image Data According to Copy Functions
2-21
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Flow of Image Data for the Fax Transmission
SO-DIMM Data expansion Data rotation Resolution conversion USB2.0 Data compression Data rotation Data expansion
SO-DIMM
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Flow of Image Data for the Fax Transmission
2-22
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Flow of Image Data for the PDL Function
PDL
Image processing block for fax
SO-DIMM Data rotation Data compression Data expansion Processing block for printer unit Compression/expansion /editing block
DC controller PCB
F-2-41
DC controller PCB
F-2-40
Technology > Controller System > Controls > Flow of Image Data for the PDL Function
2-23
2-24
No. FAN3 FAN4 FAN6 Name
Exhaust fan (rear) Exhaust fan (front) Power supply cooling fan
Software counter
The timing at which the count is incremented differs depending on the following: - Printing mode (single-sided/double sided (2nd side) or double sided (1st side)) - Target of delivery (inner finisher) Print mode Single-sided/DoubleDouble-sided (1st side) sided (2nd side) Count-up timing
No.1 delivery sensor (S12) No. 2 delivery sensor (S42) Duplex feed sensor (S7)
Function
Cools the fixing unit. Cools the fixing unit. Cools the power supply.
Error code
E805-0000 E805-0001 E805-0002 E805-0003 E804-0000 E804-0001
T-2-10
Exhaust fan (rear) (FAN3) Exhaust fan (front) (FAN4) Power supply cooling fan (FAN6)N6)
WUP
STBY
INI
PTINT
LSTR
STBY
Fan
Overview
Fan layout
60sec
*1
Full-speed
: 1/2-speed
F-2-43
*1:The fan operates at 1/2 speed only when the machine enters the standby mode after running for more than 8 minutes for fixing.
FAN3 FAN4
FAN6
F-2-42
2-24
2-25
Power supply
Internal power supply
ADF +24VR +3.3V
+3.3V +24VR
CIS
+3.3V +5VC
+24VR
+24VR Regulator
+24V
Laser scanner unit No.2 deleivery unit Cassette pedestal HVT PCB
Fixing heater
+24VS
Inner finisher
F-2-44
2-25
2-26
Energy-saving
- Press of energy-saving key - Detection of off-hook - Occurrence of job - Detection of off-hook - Occurrence of service call - Occurrence of service call - 10 seconds after completion of job or network communication
Connection to Options
Reader/ADF
n i Standby o tcu nF
Wiring inside the machine 2-cassette pedestal mode
F-2-45
The inner finisher is connected to the 2-cassette pedestal with the connectors inside the covers. It is connected to the ADF with a cable outside the machine.
Standby mode The machine is operating or ready to start operating with all power supplies provided. Energy-saving mode Only the LCD backlight for the control panel is turned off. The machine enters this mode when auto sleep timer is activated in the user mode or the energy-saving key is pressed. Sleep 1 The controller is powered but the engine is not powered. Sleep 2 The controller is not powered. The sleep 2 mode is transitioned to the sleep 1 mode when the following event occurs: - Start of print job - Press of power switch on control panel - FAX reception
2-26
Technology > Controller System > Service Operations > Service precautions
2-27
Service Operations
Reader heater
OFF OFF ON ON
Drum heater
ON OFF ON ON
T-2-11
Reference
p. 4-48
p. 4-44
T-2-12
Consumables
None.
Service precautions
None.
Technology > Controller System > Service Operations > Service precautions
2-27
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Construction > Main Configuration Parts
Scanner motor
Motor type The number of rotation Type of bearing
DC brushless motor Approx 32000rpm (1-speed control) Oil
T-2-14
Polygon mirror
The number of face
6 (40)
T-2-15
[2]
[4]
F-2-46
Controls
Synchronous control Laser intensity control Others
Main scanning direction synchronous control APC control Laser ON/OFF control Laser scanner motor control Laser shutter control
T-2-16
Name [1] Laser Unit [2] Polygon mirror [3] BD mirror [4] BD PCB
Function
Emits laser Scans the laser light in the main scanning direction Reflects the laser light in the BD PCB direction Generates the BD signa
T-2-17
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Construction > Main Configuration Parts
2-28
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Construction > Control System Configuration
2-29
Signal name
Image signal DATA C+ DATA CDATA D+ DATA DLaser control signal CTRL0-0 CTRL0-1 CTRL0-2 Scanner motor control signal POLYGON_M_FG* POLYGON_M_ACC* POLYGON_M_DEC* BD signal BD
Function
C laser image data signal entry C laser image data signal entry D laser image data signal entry D laser image data signal entry C/D laser control signal C/D laser control signal C/D laser control signal FG output signal Motor speed-up signal Motor speed-down signal BD signal
T-2-18
J2
J601
Image signal
BD signal
J1
F-2-47
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Construction > Control System Configuration
2-29
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Basic Sequence > Basic Sequence
2-30
Basic Sequence
Basic Sequence
When the control panel power switch is turned on, the laser scanner starts to rotate; when the motor rotationreaches its target revolution, the machine turns on the laser unit. Thereafter, when the Start key is turned on, themachine generates the image request signal (PVREQ) on the printer side, and turns on the laser beam withreference to the generated signal. In the case of A4, 1 sheet
STBY
INTR
STBY
PVREQ
*1: The BD signal is generated in reference to the light from laser C. The BD sensor of the BD PCB receives light from laser C but not light from laser D.
F-2-48
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Basic Sequence > Basic Sequence
2-30
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Various Controls > Controlling the Laser Activation Timing
2-31
Various Controls
Controlling the Laser Activation Timing
Laser ON/OFF Control
Laser ON/OFF control is dependent on the combination of the laser control signal (CNT1-0/11/1-2) from the image PCB. Laser control signal CNT1-2 CNT1-1 CNT1-0
0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
J8143
J8142
[1]
BD_C RE_C
J8142
[2] [5]
F-2-49
BD_D RE_D
[1] Synchronous PCB [2] Delay PCB [3] Line memory BD_C/D : BD synch signal RE_C/D : readout enable signal
[4] VDO [5] VDO signal process unit [6] Laser driver PCB
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Various Controls > Controlling the Laser Activation Timing
2-31
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Various Controls > Controlling the Laser Shutter
MEMO: Regarding BD signal formation The BD sensor of the BD PCB receives light from laser C only, and is free of light from laser D, i.e., the BDsignal is generated based on the light from laser C.
DEC
ACC
FG
[2]
[2]
F-2-52
J208
DC Controller PCB
F-2-51
[1] Laser shutter [2] Laser shutter link (works in conjunction with the right door) [3] Laser unit
Technology > Laser Exposure System > Various Controls > Controlling the Laser Shutter
2-32
Technology > Image Formation System > Basic Configuration > Specifications of Image Formation System
2-33
Developing
Transfer
Magnetic negative toner Toner detection by toner level sensor (inside sub hopper and developing unit)
Transfer roller DC constant current control: approx. 20 A Cleaning bias control: -2700V (DC constant voltage control) DC current level control (variable according to environment sensor detection, paper type, paper width, source of paper) 16 Roller diameter Cleaning bias application Charging method Separation method Static separation (Static eliminator) + Curvature separation DC constant voltage control: -2800V (high bias), -2300 (low bias) Collected into waste toner box Waste toner box capacity: approx. 750g
T-2-20
Technology > Image Formation System > Basic Configuration > Specifications of Image Formation System
2-33
Technology > Image Formation System > Basic Configuration > Major Components of Image Formation System
2-34
Function
Cartridge filled with the toner for supply Unit consisting of the photosensitive drum, primary charging roller, etc. Rotates in connection with the primary charging roller to clean its surface. Rotates in connection with the photosensitive drum to cause it negatively charged. Scrapes off the residual toner on the photosensitive drum. Feeds the toner scraped off by the cleaning blade to the waste toner box. Forms images on the surface of the photosensitive drum. Applies negative charge to the back of paper to cause it separated from the photosensitive drum. Applies positive charge to the back of a paper to cause the toner to be transferred to it. Transfers the toner in the developing unit to the photosensitive drum. Unit consisting of the developing cylinder, developing blade, etc. Feeds the toner supplied from the sub hopper into the developing unit. Feeds the toner supplied from the toner cartridge to the developing unit. Stores the toner supplied from the toner cartridge.
T-2-21
Name Toner cartridge Drum unit Brush roller Primary charging roller Cleaning blade Waste toner feed screw Photosensitive drum Static eliminator Transfer roller
[8] [9]
[12] Toner feed screw (Inside developing unit) [13] Toner feed screw (Inside sub hopper) [14] Sub hopper
[12]
[11]
[10]
F-2-53
Technology > Image Formation System > Basic Configuration > Major Components of Image Formation System
2-34
Technology > Image Formation System > Basic Configuration > Image Formation Process
2-35
Image Formation Process Description Charges the surface of the photosensitive drum to a [1] Primary charging block [2] Laser exposure block [3] Developing block
[1]
Technology > Image Formation System > Basic Configuration > Image Formation Process
2-35
Technology > Image Formation System > Basic Sequence > Sequence of Operation (last rotation)
2-36
Basic Sequence
The basic sequence is as follows.
Sheet-to-sheet sequence
Main Motor (M1) Primary charging AC bias Primary charging DC bias Laser Developing AC bias Developing DC bias Developing cylinder clutch (CL3) Transfer bias Static eliminator bias
F-2-55
F-2-57
Registration ON
F-2-58
Technology > Image Formation System > Basic Sequence > Sequence of Operation (last rotation)
2-36
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Drum Unit
2-37
Primary Charging Bias Control
The machine is directly charged by the charging roller. DC bias and AC bias that stabilized the charge is applied to the primary charging roller.
Primary charging roller Photosensitive drum
Controls
Drum Unit
The drum unit mainly consists of the photosensitive drum, primary charging roller, brush roller, cleaning blade, and waste toner feed screw, and is driven by the main motor (M1). Cleaning blade in contact with the photosensitive drum scrapes off the residual toner on its surface without being transferred to a paper. The residual toner scraped off by the cleaning blade is fed from the toner ejection part into the waste toner box by the waste toner feed screw. The primary charging roller is cleaned by the brush roller in contact with it.
Waste toner feed screw
HVT PCB
Environment sensor
[2]
[1]
DC Controller PCB
F-2-60
[1] [2]
M1 [1]
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Drum Unit
2-37
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Developing Unit
2-38
Developing Bias Control
The DC bias and AC bias are applied to the developing cylinder.
Photosensitive drum
Developing Unit
The developing unit mainly consists of the developing cylinder, developing blade, toner agitation plate, and toner feed screw, and driven by the main motor (M1) and developing cylinder clutch (CL3). The toner supplied from the toner cartridge is fed into the drum unit by the toner feed screw and toner agitation plate. The toner presence/absence in the drum unit is detected by the developing unit toner sensor (TS1) which is a magnetic permeability sensor.
Developing Blade
Environment sensor HVT PCB [3] Developing cylinder [2] [1] Developing cylinder
TS1
DC Controller PCB
F-2-62
Developing bias control signal Environment sensor detection signal Density setting signal
DC Controller PCB
F-2-61
Developing unit toner sensor Developing cylinder clutch Main motor Developing cylinder clutch drive signal Main motor drive signal Developing unit toner sensor detection signal
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Developing Unit
2-38
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Toner Container
2-39
Sub hopper Toner feed screw Route of toner supply Toner cartridge TS2
Toner Container
Toner cartridge is filled with toner and supplies to the drum unit.
Toner cartridge
M6
F-2-63
M7 [2] [1]
The toner in the toner cartridge is fed to the sub hopper and then to the developing unit by the toner feed screw. The toner presence/absence in the sub hopper is detected by the sub hopper toner sensor (TS2) which is a magnetic permeability sensor. If the developing unit toner sensor (TS1) detects the absence of the toner in the developing unit, the hopper motor (M7) drives to rotate the toner feed screw to feed toner in the sub hopper to the developing unit. Also, if the sub hopper toner sensor (TS2) detects the absence of the toner in the sub hopper, the bottle motor (M7) drives to rotate the toner cartridge to feed the toner in the toner cartridge to the sub hopper. If the sub hopper toner sensor (TS2) keeps detecting the absence of the toner for more than the specified period of time, no toner in the toner cartridge is assumed and the message to replace the toner cartridge will be displayed. Also, if the developing unit toner sensor (TS1) keeps detecting the absence of the toner for more than the specified period of time, no toner in the developing unit is assumed and a "No Toner" error message will be displayed. TS2 M1 M6 M7 [1] [2] [3] [4]
F-2-64
Sub hopper toner sensor Main motor Hopper motor Bottle motor Sub hopper toner sensor detection signal Bottle motor drive signal Main motor drive signal Hopper motor drive signal
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Toner Container
2-39
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Transfer Unit
2-40
Transfer Bias/Separation Static Eliminator Bias Control
DC bias is applied to the transfer roller and static eliminator.
Photosensitive drum
Transfer Unit
The transfer unit mainly consists of the static eliminator and transfer roller which rotates in connection with the drum unit.
Static eliminator
Static eliminator
Environment sensor
HVT PCB Transfer charging roller [3] Transfer charging roller [2] [1]
F-2-65
DC Controller PCB
F-2-66
Separation static eliminator bias control signal Transfer bias control signal Environment sensor detection signal
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Transfer Unit
2-40
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Waste Toner Box
S17
S17
F-2-67
S17
Technology > Image Formation System > Controls > Waste Toner Box
2-41
Technology > Image Formation System > Work of Service > Points to Note about Service
2-42
Work of Service
When Replacing the Components
None
Periodical Service
None
Technology > Image Formation System > Work of Service > Points to Note about Service
2-42
2-43 Specifications
Item Fixing method Fixing speed Function/method
On-demand fixing 139mm/sec (1/1-high speed: 0.8% speed-up) 137mm/sec (1/1-speed) 133mm/sec (1/1-slow speed: 3.1% speed-down) Ceramic heater 208 deg C (plain paper) *1 By the main thermistor and the sub thermistor Cleaning roller Down sequence control Loop sensor Main thermistor and Sub thermistor Thermo Switch (operating temperature: 250 deg C)
Fixing System
Overview
Features
This machine introduces the on-demand fixing method.
Fixing heater Control temperature Temperature detection Cleaning mechanism Edge heat rising prevention control Fixing loop control Protective Function
T-2-23 *1. Target temperature is specified depending on the fixing mode and the fixing temperature
Fixing heater
2-43
Technology > Fixing System > Overview > Major parts configuration
2-44
Part name --Film unit Pressure roller Fixing heater Main thermistor Function / method
Applying heat and pressure makes the toner image on paper fixed (fused).
Ceramic heater To be in contact with the heater Temperature control, detection of abnormal temperature rise Sub thermistor (rear) To be in contact with the heater (non-feeding area) Temperature control, detection of abnormal temperature rise, temperature detection/cooling control on the edges To be in contact with the heater (non-feeding area) Thermo Switch Temperature control, detection of abnormal temperature rise, temperature detection/cooling control on the edges Fixing outlet sensor Jam detection
T-2-24
Fixing outlet sensor (S19) Thermo switch (TP1) Main thermistor (TH1)
Technology > Fixing System > Overview > Major parts configuration
2-44
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Fixing temperature control: overview
2-45
Controls
Fixing temperature control: overview
Standby temperature control
To preheat the fixing assembly to reduce time for starting print Flying start temperature control
F-2-70
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Fixing temperature control: overview
2-45
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Print temperature control
Max. 10 sec
F-2-71
F-2-72
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Print temperature control
2-46
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Print temperature control
2-47
Target temperature during printing The control temperature is determined according to the fixing mode or to the fixing temperature at the start of warm-up control. The 12 modes are provided as the fixing mode for the selected feed table and paper type. The following table is the control temperature when the fixing temperature is less than 55 deg C at the start of warm-up control.
C.Sheet-to-sheet distance temperature control To prevent the excessive temperature rise and to save the power consumption, the target temperature is set 5 deg C low (in case of plain paper *1) from the printing temperature. *1. Set to 5, 15 or 20 deg C low according paper type
Fixing mode
Setting
Paper type Plain paper Thin paper S-thin paper Heavy paper Heavy paper-H Bond paper OHP Postcard S-Postcard Envelope N1 N3
Related Service Mode Offset of fixing control temperature (High and low of control temperature)
PRINT > SW > 62 (Control temperature during cassette feeding) > 63 (Control temperature in Heavy/Heavy-H/Bond paper modes) > 166 (Control temperature for the second side of 2-sided copying) > 173 (Control temperature for the second side of 2-sided copying) > 179 (Control temperature in Postcard/S-Postcard/Envelope modes) 0 to 2: +15 deg C 3 to 11: +12 to -15 deg C (each 3 deg C) [Default: 7] 12 to 14: -15 deg C
<Setting value>
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Print temperature control
2-47
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Down sequence control
2-48
Fixing mode Step B4 LGL
13 13 10 8 4 -
B5 EXE
27/25/20 27/25/20 27/25/20 10 4 -
A4R LTRR
17 17 14 10 4 -
Free size
13 13 10 8 4 -
Post -card
12 10 8 8 4 6 5 4 4 2 -
Envelope
OHP
Postcard
1st step
245
2nd step
255
3rd step
275
S-Postcard
T-2-26
Temperature is reduced by making wider sheet-to-sheet distance with the maximum 4 steps to control the temperature at lower than the target temperature for normal print. Fixing mode Step B4 LGL
13 13 10 8 4 11 11 10 8 4 8 8 8 8 4
Envelope
B5 EXE
27/25/20 27/25/20 27/25/20 10 4 23/20 23/20 23/20 10 4 8 8 8 8 4
A4R LTRR
17 17 14 10 4 13 13 13 10 4 8 8 8 8 4
Free size
13 13 10 8 4 4 4 4 4 4 8 8 8 8 4
Post -card
-
Envelope
10 8 6 6 3
T-2-27
Bond paper
Completion conditions: When the fixing temperature reaches 175 deg C and lower for 430 msec continuously after shifting to the third or fourth step, the productivity returns to the second step.
F-2-73
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Down sequence control
2-48
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Down sequence control
2-49
Down sequence when switching paper size
Purpose: This down sequence prevents temperature rise of non-feeding area: there can be possible fixing offset or wrinkle of the succeeding paper due to increased temperature of non-feeding area of the preceding paper when continuously making prints or feeding wider length of paper than the preceding paper.
Setting for down sequence start temperature when feeding small size paper PRINT > SW > 64 0: +20 deg C 1: +10 deg C 2: 0 deg C [Default: 2] 3: -10 deg C 4: -20 deg C
<Setting value>
Normal
235deg C, 430msec
1st Step
245deg C, 430msec
2nd Step
255deg C, 430msec
3rd Step
275deg C, 430msec
4th Step
F-2-74
Starting conditions: If the detected temperature of the sub thermistor reaches more than 210 deg C (*1) when switching to the paper which has longer width than the preceding paper. Operation: Pickup of the succeeding paper and power distribution to the heater are stopped as well to decrease the fixing temperature. Completion conditions: When the detected temperature of the sub thermistor reaches 170 deg C and less (*1) *1. It is different according to setting value of the user mode (Special mode S or Rotation/collation adjustment)
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Down sequence control
2-49
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > User mode related to fixing grade
2-50
*1. N1 mode: "Normal temperature control" -24 deg C (when the cassette feeding, and the fixing temperature is 100 deg C or more at the start of warm-up control.) *2. N3 mode: "Normal temperature control" -48 deg C (when the cassette feeding, and the fixing temperature is 100 deg C or more at the start of warm-up control.) *3. The setting of rotation/collation mode is given priority to over this setting.
Off Normal temperature control (Default) (Plain paper mode) Auto (Fixing grade Fixing mode (plain paper mode is improved) and N1 mode (*1)) is changed automatically according to the environment (temperature/ humidity). Manual (Medium) N1 mode temperature control (Fixing grade is improved) Manual (High) N3 mode (*3) temperature control (Fixing grade is improved) The fixing mode is Off Normal temperature control Special Mode P (Plain paper mode) (To prevent a curl changed when either (Default) of the plain/ recycled/ Medium Thin paper mode temperature of thin paper/ color/ 3-hole paper is (Fixing grade is control recycle paper) selected in the control improved) panel. The productivity High S-thin paper mode temperature is reduced and fixing (Fixing grade is control grade is improved. improved) The productivity is Off Normal control Special Mode G reduced and fixing (Default) (To increase the grade is improved. On The productivity is reduced by 4 fixing grade for (Fixing grade is sheets or 5 sheets. heavy paper) improved) The down sequence Off Temperature difference between Special Mode G time is reduced (Default) the main and sub thermistors to (To increase the when switching the start the paper feeding: 20 deg C productivity during Temperature difference between paper size. The fixing On down sequence) grade is reduced and (Productivity is the main and sub thermistors to start the paper feeding: 30 deg C productivity is improved. improved) (*3) The down sequence Image Priority Temperature difference between Special Mode F time is reduced in the (Default) the main and sub thermistors to (To reduce the collation adjustment start the paper feeding: 20 deg C wait time during Speed Priority 1 Temperature difference between mode. The fixing rotation/ collation grade is reduced and (Productivity is the main and sub thermistors to adjustment mode) productivity is improved. improved) start the paper feeding: 40 deg C Speed Priority 2 Temperature difference between the (Productivity is main and sub thermistors to start improved more) the paper feeding: 60 deg C
T-2-28
The fixing mode is changed when either of the plain/ recycled/ color/ 3-hole paper is selected in the control panel. The productivity is reduced and fixing grade is improved.
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > User mode related to fixing grade
2-50
2
Purpose:
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Paper loop amount control before fixing
2-51
reduced speed is kept until the loop sensor is turned on by the formed paper loop. 4) Repeat steps 2) and 3). The fixing motor drive speed is increased by 0.8% compared with the process speed when the trailing edge of paper reaches 65 mm before coming out of the registration roller. 5) When continuously making prints, return to step 1). When making a single print,
Fixing film
Pressure roller
Drum
Sensor: OFF
Registration roller
Sensor: ON
F-2-75
Starting conditions: This control is performed at every paper feeding. Operation: The fixing motor drive speed is controlled as follows by detecting the paper loop between transfer roller and fixing roller with the loop sensor. 1) The fixing motor drive speed is reduced by 3.1% when the reading edge of paper is fed 35mm from the transfer roller. The reduced speed is kept until the loop sensor is turned on by the formed paper loop. 2) After detecting the ON condition of the loop sensor for 50 msec continuously, the fixing motor drive speed is increased by 0.8% compared with the process speed. The increased speed is kept until the loop sensor is turned off by the deleted paper loop. 3) After detecting the OFF condition of the loop sensor for 50 msec continuously, the fixing motor drive speed is reduced by 3.1% compared with the process speed. The
Technology > Fixing System > Controls > Paper loop amount control before fixing
2-51
2-52
Error Clear
Protection features
Code E000 Description
Fixing temperature abnormal rise 0001 The temperature detected by the main thermistor does not rise to the Yes specified value during startup control. Fixing unit temperature rise detection 0000 The reading of the main thermistor is 250 deg C or more continuously Yes for 200 msec. 0001 0002 The hardware circuit detects overheating of the main or sub thermistor Yes for 200 msec. The reading of the sub thermistor is 295 deg C or more continuously Yes for 200 msec. Yes
E001
E002
Fixing unit temperature insufficient rise 0000 1.The reading of the main thermistor is less than 115 deg C continuously for 400 msec 1.3 sec after it has indicated 100 deg C. 2.The reading of the main thermistor is less than 150 deg C continuously for 400 msec 1.3 sec after it has indicated 140 deg C.
E003
Low fixing temperature detection after standby 0000 The reading of the main thermistor is less than 140 deg C continuously Yes for 400 msec or more. Thermistor disconnection detection error 0000 When disconnection is detected with connector (J214) for 30 sec continuously. Unstable rotation of the Fixing Motor (M2) 0001 Detection is executed every 100 msec after the start of motor rotation; however, the drive detection signal is absent for 2 sec. 0002 During motor rotation, detection is executed every 100 msec; however, No the drive signal is absent 5 times in sequence. No No
E004
E014
E261
Error in Zero Cross 0000 Zero Cross failed to be detected for 500ms or more while the relay was ON. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed.
T-2-29
2-52
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Parts Configuration
[15] [14]
[13] [12] [11] [10] [9] [8] [7] [6] [5] [4] [3] [2] [1]
550 sheets (80 g/m2), 650 sheets (64 g/m2) 100 sheets (80 g/m2), 100 sheets (64 g/m2) Center reference A4, A4R, A3, A5R, B4, B5, B5R, LTR, LTTR, LG, 11" x 17", STMTR A4, A4R, A3, A5R, B4, B5, B5R, LTR, LTTR, LG, Cassette 2 11"" x 17"", STMTR, Envelopes* (No.10 (COM10), ISO-B5, Monarch, ISO-C5, DL) * The optional Envelope Feeder Attachment-D1 is required. Manual feed pickup tray A4, A4R, A3, A5R, B4, B5, B5R, LTR, LTTR, LG, 11" x 17", STMTR, Free size (99 mm x 297 mm to 148 mm x 432 mm), Envelopes (No.10 (COM10), ISO-B5, Monarch, ISO-C5, DL) 64 g/m2 to 90 g/m2 Cassette Manual feed pickup tray 64 g/m2 to 128 g/m2 By the user Cassette Manual feed pickup tray By the user Through path
T-2-30
F-2-76
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Parts Configuration
2-53
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Parts Configuration
2-54
Arrangement of Rollers (250-sheet 1st cassette model)
[19] [18] [17] [16] [15]
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16] [17] [18] [19] [20]
Separation roller (cassette 1) Feed roller (cassette 1) Vertical path slave roller 1 Pickup roller (cassette 1) Manual feed pull-up roller Manual feed pickup roller Registration roller Transfer roller Duplexing/feeding roller 2 Drum Duplexing/feeding roller 1 Fixing pressure roller Fixing film Fixing outlet roll 1 Fixing outlet roll 2 Duplexing inlet roller Vertical path slave roller 2 Tray 1 delivery roller Tray 2 delivery roller Reversing roller
[14] [13]
[12] [11] [10] [9] [8] [7] [6] [5] [4] [3] [2] [1]
F-2-77
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Parts Configuration
2-54
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Parts Configuration
2-55
Arrangement of Sensors (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16] [17] [18] [19]
Separation pad (cassette 1) Pickup roller (cassette 1) Vertical path slave roller 1 Manual feed pull-up roller Manual feed pickup roller Registration roller Transfer roller Duplexing/feeding roller 2 Drum Duplexing/feeding roller 1 Fixing pressure roller Fixing film Fixing outlet roll 1 Fixing outlet roll 2 Duplexing inlet roller Vertical path slave roller 2 Tray 1 delivery roller Tray 2 delivery roller Reversing roller
S40
S42
S12
S19
S6 S7 S5 S9 S1 S4 S3 S2
F-2-78
Cassette 1 pickup sensor Cassette 1 paper sensor Cassette 1 paper level sensor A Cassette 1 paper level sensor B Pre-registration sensor Loop sensor Duplex feed sensor Manual feeder paper sensor No.1 delivery sensor Fixing outlet sensor Reversal sensor No. 2 delivery sensor
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Parts Configuration
2-55
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Parts Configuration
2-56
Route of Drive (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
M1 M10
S40 SL4
S42
2 Way Unit
SL2 S2
F-2-79
SL1
Cassette 1 paper sensor Pre-registration sensor Loop sensor Duplex feed sensor Manual feeder paper sensor No.1 delivery sensor Fixing outlet sensor Reversal sensor No. 2 delivery sensor
F-2-80
Main motor Fixing motor Reversal motor Pickup solenoid Manual feed pickup solenoid No.1 delivery reversal solenoid
Reversal solenoid No.2 delivery solenoid Registration clutch Manual feed pickup clutch Duplex feed clutch
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Parts Configuration
2-56
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Diagram of Paper Paths (w/ 2 Way Unit/ inaner 2 way tray)
2-57
SL4
Reversing point 2 Way Unit Delivery to tray 2 (option) SL5 SL3 M2 Delivery to tray 1
CL4
CL1 CL2 Pickup from manual feeder SL2 SL1 Pickup from cassette 1
F-2-81
Main motor Fixing motor Reversal motor Pickup solenoid Manual feed pickup solenoid No.1 delivery reversal solenoid
Reversal solenoid No.2 delivery solenoid Registration clutch Manual feed pickup clutch Duplex feed clutch
F-2-82
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Diagram of Paper Paths (w/ 2 Way Unit/ inaner 2 way tray)
2-57
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Diagram of Paper Paths (w/o 2 Way Unit)
Reversing point
Pickup from manual feeder Pickup from cassette 1 Pickup from cassette 1
F-2-83
F-2-84
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Diagram of Paper Paths (w/o 2 Way Unit)
2-58
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Diagram of Paper Paths (w/o 2 Way Unit)
2-59
F-2-85
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Overview > Diagram of Paper Paths (w/o 2 Way Unit)
2-59
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-60
Controls
Overview
moved down. When the pickup roller comes into contact with the surface of paper, the sheet is picked up by rotation of the roller. Only a single sheet of paper picked up is moved to the feed path by the feed roller and the separation roller, and moved as far as the registration roller by the pickup vertical path roller. The pickup vertical path roller, pickup roller, feed roller, and separation roller are driven by the cassette pickup motor (M1).
[1] [4] [2]
[3]
[5] Pickup roller Feed roller Separation roller Pickup vertical path roller Lifter plate
F-2-87
[5]
Outline Paper Level / Presence Detection Paper Size / Cassette Presence Detection Multi-Purpose Pickup Assembly Outline Paper Presence Detection Paper Size Detection Fixing / Registration Assembly Registration Control Duplex Feed Control Duplex / Delivery Assembly JAM Detection JAM Detection
T-2-31
Detection, Control
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-60
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-61
Cassette size switch (SW7)
SW6 SW7
Detection dial
F-2-88
F-2-89
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-61
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-62
B5 EXEC 16K A5-R A4 STMT-R LTR B5-R LTR-R A4-R LGL B4 8K A3 LDR
Width 257.0 267.0 270.0 148.5 297.0 139.7 279.4 182.0 215.9 210.0 215.9 257.0 270.0 297.0 279.4
Length 182.0 184.0 195.0 210.0 210.0 215.9 215.9 257.0 279.4 297.0 355.6 364.0 390.0 420.0 431.8
1
0 0 0 ON 0 ON 0 ON 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Width detection 2 3
ON ON ON 0 ON 0 ON 0 0 0 0 ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON 0 ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON 0 ON
4
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1
0 0 ON ON ON ON ON 0 ON 0 ON ON ON 0 0
Length detection 2 3
0 0 0 ON ON ON ON ON 0 ON ON ON ON 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ON 0 ON 0 ON ON ON ON
Size should be found manually on the check screen for the combination of A5-Rand STMT-R or the combination of B5-R and EXEC. Specify the ecognition method for the special paper with user setting. The setting size is indicated below. Related Service Mode PRINT> CST> CASX> CSTX-UY> Number X shows Cassette Number. Y shows size category. (X, Y is one of the number 1/2/3/4.) U-size.
U1 U2 U3 U4
Size
26: OFI, 27: E-OFI, 37: M-OFI, 36: A-OFI, 24: FLSP, 25: A-FLSP, 30: A-LTRR, 42: FA4, 34: G-LGL 0: default 32: G-LTR-R, 34: G-LGL, 23: K-LGL-R, 0: default 22: K-LGL, 31: G-LTR, 29: A-LTR, 0: default 28: B-OFI, 0: default
T-2-33
Also, the cassette presence is detected when the size switch is pushed. (If no switch is pushed, it is determined as no cassette.)
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-62
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-63
If the paper is full Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor A Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor B Paper
OFF OFF If the paper is approx.half Cassette 1 paper level sensor A (S3) Cassette 1 paper level sensor B (S4) Flag Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor B Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor A Paper
OFF ON If the paper is a little Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor B Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor A Paper
Lifter gear
Tray
F-2-90 F-2-91
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-63
2
Cassette 1 paper level sensor A
OFF ON ON ---
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-64
Paper level
Display
Overview
The paper inside the cassette is held up by the lifter plate. When pickup takes place, the pickup solenoid (SL1) is turned on, and the pickup roller rotates once. When the pickup roller comes into contact with the surface of paper, the sheet is picked up by rotation of the roller. Only a single sheet of paper picked up is moved to the feed path by the separation pad, and moved as far as the registration roller by the pickup vertical path roller. The pickup vertical path roller and pickup roller are driven by the cassette pickup motor (M1).
Pickup roller Separation roller Pickup vertical path roller Lifter plate
F-2-92
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-64
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-65
Cassette size switch (SW7) Rear detection rink
SW7
Detection dial
F-2-93
Detection dial
F-2-94
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-65
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-66
B5 EXEC 16K A5-R A4 STMT-R LTR B5-R LTR-R A4-R LGL B4 8K A3 LDR
Width 257.0 267.0 270.0 148.5 297.0 139.7 279.4 182.0 215.9 210.0 215.9 257.0 270.0 297.0 279.4
Length 182.0 184.0 195.0 210.0 210.0 215.9 215.9 257.0 279.4 297.0 355.6 364.0 390.0 420.0 431.8
1
0 0 0 ON 0 ON 0 ON 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Width detection 2 3
ON ON ON 0 ON 0 ON 0 0 0 0 ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON 0 ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON 0 ON
4
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1
0 0 ON ON ON ON ON 0 ON 0 ON ON ON 0 0
Length detection 2 3
0 0 0 ON ON ON ON ON 0 ON ON ON ON 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ON 0 ON 0 ON ON ON ON
Size should be found manually on the check screen for the combination of A5-Rand STMT-R or the combination of B5-R and EXEC. Specify the ecognition method for the special paper with user setting. The setting size is indicated below. Related Service Mode PRINT> CST> CASX> CSTX-UY> Number X shows Cassette Number. Y shows size category. (X, Y is one of the number 1/2/3/4.) U-size.
U1 U2 U3 U4
Size
26: OFI, 27: E-OFI, 37: M-OFI, 36: A-OFI, 24: FLSP, 25: A-FLSP, 30: A-LTRR, 42: FA4, 34: G-LGL 0: default 32: G-LTR-R, 34: G-LGL, 23: K-LGL-R, 0: default 22: K-LGL, 31: G-LTR, 29: A-LTR, 0: default 28: B-OFI, 0: default
T-2-37
Also, the cassette presence is detected when the size switch is pushed. (If no switch is pushed, it is determined as no cassette.)
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette model)
2-66
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Multi-Purpose Pickup Assembly
Paper level
paper presence paper absent
Display
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Multi-Purpose Pickup Assembly
2-67
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Fixing / Registration Assembly
2-68
M1 M10
Reverse mouth 2
SL4
2 Way Unit
M1
CL1
Registration roller
F-2-97
S7
F-2-98
Reverse mouth 1: with 2 way unit Reverse mouth 2: without 2 way unit
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Fixing / Registration Assembly
2-68
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Detecting Jams
Type
Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Wrong size specified
Sensor Name
Cassette 1 pickup sensor Pre-registration sensor Fixing outlet sensor No. 1 delivery sensor No. 2 delivery sensor Reversal sensor Duplex feed sensor Cassette 1 pickup sensor Pre-registration sensor Fixing outlet sensor No. 1 delivery sensor No. 2 delivery sensor Reversal sensor Duplex feed sensor Cassette 1 pickup sensor Pre-registration sensor Fixing outlet sensor No. 1 delivery sensor No. 2 delivery sensor Reversal sensor Duplex feed sensor Pre-registration sensor S1 S5 S19 S12 S42 S40 S7 S1 S5 S19 S12 S42 S40 S7 S1 S5 S19 S12 S42 S40 S7 S5
Sensor ID
T-2-41
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Controls > Detecting Jams
2-69
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Work of Service > Periodically Servicing
2-70
Work of Service
Periodical ServicePeriodical Service
None
Consumables
No. Item Parts No. Q'ty iR2530/2525 iR2530/2525/2520 (550-sheet 1st (250-sheet 1st cassette type) cassette type)
1 1 FL3-1352 FL3-1447 1 1
Life
Remarks
1 2 3 4
Manual feed pickup FL3-1352 roller Manual feed separation FL3-3469 pad Cassette pickup roller (For 250-sheet cassette) Cassette separation pad (For 250-sheet cassette) Cassette pickup roller FB6-3405 (For 550-sheet cassette) Cassette transfer roller FC6-7083 (For 550-sheet cassette)
Cassette separation roller (For 550-sheet cassette) Cassette idler gear (Only for 550-sheet cassette for China)
FC6-6661
FU3-0280
*1 or 120,000 *: Quantity 2 sheets indicates number of 550 sheets cassette. *1 or 120,000 Replace with 2 sheets cassette separation pad. *: Quantity indicates number of 550 sheets cassette. *1 or 120,000 *: Quantity 2 sheets indicates number of 550 sheets cassette. *1 or 120,000 *: Quantity 2 sheets indicates number of 550 sheets cassette.
T-2-42
Periodically Servicing
None
Technology > Pickup Feed System > Work of Service > Periodically Servicing
2-70
Technology > Embedded RDS > Product Overview > Features and benefits
Embedded RDS
Product Overview
Overview
EMBEDDED RDS(hereafter, referred to as E-RDS) is a network module embedded with customer's device, and enables e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote (Remote Diagnosis System), which can collects and transmits status changes, counter values, error log and consumable information such as toner low/ out of the device to UGW via Internet. The following device information / status can be monitored. Service Mode Counter (Billing counts) Parts Counter Mode Counter Firmware Info. Device Condition log Service Call Error log Jam log Status changes (Toner low/ out, etc.)
Internet
DNS server
Proxy server
Intranet
Firewall
UGW
F-2-99
Technology > Embedded RDS > Product Overview > Features and benefits
2-71
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Network settings
E-RDS Setup
To monitor a Copier/ MFP with e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote, the following settings are required.
Advance preparations
(1) Advance confirmation Confirm with the UGW administrator that the device to be monitored with e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote is registered in the UGW. (2) Advance preparations Interview the user's system administrator in advance to find out the following information about the network. Information item 1 IP address settings Automatic setting (DHCP, RARP, BOOTP) Manual setting IP address, subnet mask and gateway address to be set Information item 2 Is there a DNS server in use? If there is a DNS server in use, find out the following. Primary DNS server address Secondary DNS server address Information item 3 Is there a proxy server? If there is a proxy server in use, find out the following. Proxy server address Port No. for proxy server Information item 4 Is proxy server authentication required? If proxy server authentication is required, find out the following. User name and password required for proxy authentication
IP Address Settings
a. Move on to Settings/ Registration > System Settings > Network Settings > TCP/IP Settings > IPv4 Settings > IP Address Settings.
F-2-100
b. Set the IP address, based on the information obtained under (2) Advance preparations, Information item 1, described above. For automatic acquisition, select from [DHCP], [RARP], [BOOTP]. For manual setting, set the following by numeric keys. IP Address Subnet Mask Gateway Address Example) 172. 001. 016. 200 Example) 255. 255. 255. 0 Example) 172. 001. 016. 254
F-2-101
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Network settings
2-72
2
c. Press [OK].
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Network settings
2-73
1) Select Primary DNS Server, and then set the DNS server address. Example) 172. 001.016. 010
d. Press [Done].
DNS Settings
e. Move on to Settings/ Registration > System Settings > Network Settings > TCP/IP Settings > IPv4 Settings > DNS Server.
F-2-104
2) If secondary DNS server is set, select and set Secondary DNS Server address. 3) 4) press [OK].
If DNS host name is used, select DNS Host Name/Domain Name Settings, and then
F-2-102
specify the host name. If a DHCP server is established and DNS Dynamic Update Settings is not applied, reserve the fix IP address to said device. g. Press [Done].
f. Set the DNS settings, based on the information obtained under (2) Advance preparations, Information item 2, described above. Select DNS Server Address Settings, if IP addresses are specified directly.
F-2-103
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Network settings
2-73
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Network settings
2-74
4) If proxy authentication is required, press [Authentication Settings]. 5) Set the Proxy Authentication Settings, based on the information obtained under (2) Advance preparations, Information item 4, described above. Select [ON] in Use Proxy Authentication. Enter User name and Password, and then press [OK].
Proxy Settings
h. If proxy server is set, move on to Setting/ Registration > System Settings > Network Settings > TCP/IP Settings > Proxy Settings.
F-2-105
i. Set the Proxy Settings, based on the information obtained under (2) Advance preparations, Information item 3, described above. 1) Select [ON] in Use Proxy. 2) Select Server Address, and then set the Proxy server address. Example) proxy.canon.com 3) Enter Port Number. Example) 80 (1- 65535)
F-2-107
6) Press [OK]. j. Press [Done]. k. Press Reset button to quit the Setting/ Registration. l. Turn the device power OFF/ ON.
F-2-106
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Network settings
2-74
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Steps to E-RDS Settings
2-75
The example of the service mode indication screen
Description
0: Disable/ 1:Enable e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system to send device information, counter data, error statuses to the UGW. Default value is 0 (not in use) URL of UGW (default) https://a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif010 The UGW Port Number by default : 443 Validation: 1~ 65,535 Perform Communication test with UGW and set "OK"/ "NG" as the result Detailed communication log displays the last 5 error information, consisting of data, error code, and error reasons up to now Max 5 latest loggings retained Max 128 characters for Error information. Reset E-RDS settings After executing #CLEAR > CA-KEY, if the power is turned OFF and then ON, CA certificate file is automatically installed.
T-2-43
F-2-108
#E-RDS E-RDS SWITCH Key #E-RDS RGW-ADDRESS Key #E-RDS RGW-PORT Key #E-RDS COM-TEST Key #E-RDS COM-LOG
OK Key
#E-RDS 001
129 bytes #E-RDS > RGW-ADDRESS (SJIS not allowed) 2 bytes #E-RDS > RGW-PORT #E-RDS > COM-TEST #E-RDS > COM-LOG
OK Key
#RGW-ADDRESS :A https://a01.ugwdevi..
OK Key
#RGW-PORT 001
443
OK Key
#E-RDS COM-TEST OK
OK Key
Hereafter, the procedure of enabling E-RDS application is shown. a. Enter servicemode and select #CLEAR > ERDS-DAT, and then touch [OK]. After executing the procedure a. (#CLEAR > ERDS-DAT), install or delete the CA certificate file as necessary, and then turn OFF and then ON the power. Installation of CA certificate file: Use SST to install. Deletion of CA certificate file: Execute #CLEAR > CA-KEY. (CA certificate file is automatically installed.)
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Steps to E-RDS Settings
2-75
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Initializing E-RDS settings
b. Select #E-RDS SWITCH and set value " " then touch [OK]. The communication with UGW is enabled by the above setting. 0 : OFF( initial value): e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote is disabled. 1 : ON: e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote is enabled
The following settings i.e. RGW-PORT and RGW-ADR in servicemode must not be change unless there are specific instructions to do so. Changing these values will cause error in communication with UGW.
c. Select COM-TEST and then touch [OK]. This initiates the communication test between the device and the UGW. If the communication is successful, OK is displayed. If NG (failed) appears, refer to the troubleshooting guide and repeat until OK! is displayed. MEMO: The communication results with UGW can be distinguished by referring to the communication log. By performing the communication test with UGW, E-RDS acquires schedule information and starts monitoring and meter reads operation.
In case of replacing the CA certificate file, even #CLEAR is executed, the status is not returned to the factory default. When installing the certificate file other than the factory default CA certificate file, it is required to delete the certificate file after E-RDS initialization and install the factory
Communication log
(1) COM-LOG #E-RDS COM-LOG Move on to COM-TEST by using Left/ Right allow key. The maximum 5 records logged Only for the head portion of the error details written on COM-LOG is displayed. (2) Details of communication log You can use communication log to verify that a detailed error code SOAP method name, etc. are displayed at the time of communication test failure. By pressing ? key or OK key, progressive information (generating date/ time of error) is displayed. Error details will be displayed when OK key is again pressed in the state line where generating time is displayed. Error information: within maximum 128 character strings (NULL is not included). Refer to the error list for the message strings displayed on the COM-LOG.
Technology > Embedded RDS > E-RDS Setup > Initializing E-RDS settings
2-76
2
FAQ
2-77
authentication with E-RDS can be done. Q7: Can I turn the device power off during the e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system operation? A7: While operating the e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system, the power of the device must be ON. If power OFF is needed, do not leave the device power OFF for long time. It will become "Device is busy, try later" errors if the power supply of network equipment such as HUB is made prolonged OFF. Q8: Describe about the behavior of E-RDS while enabling the Real Deep Sleep functionality. A8: While being in Real Deep Sleep, and if data to be sent is in E-RDS, the system wakes up asleep, then starts to send the data to the UGW. The system also waits for completion of data transmission and let the device to shift to asleep status again. However, transition time to the Real Deep Sleep depends on the device, and the transition to sleep won't be done if the next data transmission will be done within 10 minutes. Q9: Is E-RDS compatible with Section counter (Department counter)? A9: No, E-RDS does not support Section counter. Q10: Is E-RDS operation possible to a device which used IPv6? A10: It depends on UGW side, however IPv6 has not been supported by UGW3.0.
Q1: Registration information of an E-RDS is once deleted from the UGW server, and is reregistered after that. If a communication test is not carried out, then device information on the UGW becomes invalid. A1: When registration of the E-RDS is deleted from the UGW, the status will be changed to that the communication test has not completed because related information has lost from a database. So, device information will also become invalid if that condition will be left for seven days without carrying out the communication test. Q2: A communication test with the UGW results NG! A2: On the conditions which have not changed a server's address or port number, the following cases can be considered in the case where a communication test serves as NG. 1. Name resolution was failed due to an incorrect host name or DNS server has been halted. 2. Network cable is blocked off. 3. Proxy server settings is not correct. Q3: Let me know the interval of data transmitting from E-RDS to the UGW, and what data size is sent to the UGW? A3: The schedule of data transmitting, the start time are determined by settings in the UGW side. The timing is once per 16 hours by default, and counter data volume could be maximum 250 bytes. Q4: Does error-retry carry out at the time of a communication error with the UGW? A4: The retry of SOAP communication is performed as follows. As for postAlert data, three times of data which failed transmitting to the UGW by some external causes can be stored in RAMDISK, and will be resent at the predetermined intervals. Moreover, the data which failed in transmission is resent at the predetermined intervals at the time of SOAP transmitting error generating at the time of a jam log and service call log transmission. Q5: How many log-data can be stored? A5: Up to 5 log records can be accumulated. The data size of error information is maximum 128 bytes. Q6: Although Microsoft ISA as a proxy server is introduced, the authentication check is failed. Can E-RDS adopt with Microsoft ISA? A6: "Integrated" authentication is used for Microsoft ISA though, E-RDS must comply with "Basic." Therefore if you can change to "Basic" authentication on the server, the
2-77
2-78
3) Confirmation from another PC connected to same network. a) Request the user to ping the main unit from a PC connected to same network. Does the main unit respond? YES: Proceed to Step 4). NO: Confirm the details of the main unit's IP address and subnet mask settings. 4) Confirm DNS connection a) Settings/ Registration > System Settings > Network Settings > TCP/ IP Settings > IPv4 Settings > DNS Server > DNS Server Address Settings, and note down both the primary and secondary DNS server addresses. b) Press Reset key. c) Settings/ Registration > System Settings > Network Settings > TCP/ IP Settings > IPv4 Settings > PING command. Input the primary DNS server noted down in step a) as the IP address, and then touch Start. Is the response from the host displayed? YES: Proceed to Remedy2. NO: Input the secondary DNS server noted down in step a) as the IP address, and then touch Start. Is the response from the host displayed? YES: Proceed to Remedy2. NO: There is a possibility that the DNS server address is wrong. Reconfirm the address with the user's system administrator. Remedy2: Troubleshooting using communication log
Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting
When the communication test with UGW is NG, trouble shooting is performed according to the following steps. No.1 A communication test (COM-TEST) results NG
Causes: Initial settings or network conditions is incomplete. Remedy1: 1) Check network connections Is the status indicator LED for the HUB port to which the main unit is connected ON? YES: Proceed to Step 2). NO: Check that the network cable is properly connected. 2) Confirm loop back address a) Settings/ Registration > System Settings > Network Settings > TCP/ IP Settings > IPv4 Settings > PING Command. Input 127.0.0.1, and touch the Start button.
F-2-110
a) Enter Servicemode > #E-RDS > COM-LOG, and the following communication log will be displayed. Maximum 5 records are logged.
No:1 Ecode:840F2003 2009 01/09 17:27
Is the response from the host displayed? YES: Proceed to Step 3). NO: There is a possibility that the main unit's network settings are wrong. Check the details of the IPv4 settings once more.
b) Select a log line and touch OK, then move on to log details.
*Network is not rea dy , try later : get
2-78
2
No.2
Technology > Embedded RDS > Troubleshooting > Error code and strings
Cause: No proper firmware has been installed, or E-RDS settings have not been completed. Remedy: The following points should be checked. 1) Check the firmware compatibility of device. 2) Check network conditions such as proxy server settings and so on. 3) Check E-RDS setting. a) Check the communication log from COM-LOG. b) If RGW-ADR or RGW-PORT setting has changed, restore default value by Servicemode > #CLEAR > ERDS-DAT. c) If CA certificate file has changed, restore the original certificate file installed at the factory shipment to the device by using a service support tool.
No.3
There was a log, indicating "Network is not ready, try later (No.22)" in error
details of COM-LOG list. Causes: A certain problem occurred in networking. Remedy: Check and take actions mentioned below. 1) Check networking conditions and connections. 2) Turn on the power supply of a device and perform a communication test (Servicemode > #E-RDS > COM-TEST about 60 seconds later. 3 2
The communication test Select and perform Servicemode > had not been performed, #E-RDS > COM-TEST. though E-RDS is enabled. Turn the device OFF/ ON. If the error persists, replace the device system software. (Upgrade) Check that the value of Service mode > #E-RDS > RGW-ADR is https://a01. ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif010. Check the network connection, as per the initial procedures described in the troubleshooting.
No.4
successfully. Causes: A certain problem was in the server side, or possibly a network load has been added. Remedy: The following points should be checked. 1) Change data transmission schedules, and then see how things going. 2) Try again after a period of time. If the same error persists, check the UGW status with a network and UGW administrator. 6 5
Processing (event processing) within the device has failed. The header of the URL of 8xxx URL Scheme the registered UGW is not 2001 error(not https) in https format. 8xxx Server connection Displayed in the event of a TCP/IP communication 200A error fault. Also displayed when an attempt is made at communication with the device IP address not set. A URL different to that 8xxx URL server 2002 specified is illegal specified by the UGW has been set. 8xxx Proxy connection Could not connect to proxy server due to improper 2014 error address. Proxy authentication is 8xxx Proxy failed. 201E authentication
Check that the value of Service mode > #E-RDS > RGW-ADR can be https:// a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif010. Check proxy server address and reenter as needed. Check the user name and password required in order to login to the proxy, and re-enter as needed.
error
Technology > Embedded RDS > Troubleshooting > Error code and strings
2-79
2
No. Code 8
Technology > Embedded RDS > Troubleshooting > Error code and strings
2-80
Error character strings 14 8xxx Server response 2004 error (NULL) No. Code Causes Remedy
Try again after a period of time. If the same error occurs again, check the UGW status with the UGW administrator.
Causes
Could not connect to proxy server due to name resolution error.
Remedy
Check that the proxy server name is correct. If the proxy server name is correct, check the DNS connection, as per the troubleshooting initial procedures. Install the latest device system software. (Upgrade)
No route certificate installed in device. Certificate other than that initially registered in the user's operating environment is being used, but has not been registered with the device The server certificate Check that Service mode > #E-RDS verification error occurred. > RGW-ADDRESS can be https:// (URL check error) a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif010.is correct. The device time and Check that the device time and date date is outside of the are correctly set. If the device time and certificated period.-T he date are correct, upgrade to the latest route certificate registered system software. with the device has expired. Certificate other than that initially registered in the user's operating environment is being used, but has not been registered with the device. Some other kind of Try again after a period of time. If communication error has persists, check the UGW status with occurred. the UGW administrator. SOAP communication error Check that the value of Service mode has occurred. > #E-RDS > RGW-PORT can be 443.
15 8xxx 2004
Displayed when communication with UGW has been successful, but an error of some sort has prevented UGW from responding. When (Null) is displayed at the end of the message, this indicates that there has been an error in the HTTPS communication method. Displayed when Server communication with UGW response error has been successful, but (Hexadecimal]) an error of some sort has [Error details in prevented UGW from UGW ] *1 responding.(Hexadecimal) displayed at the end of the message is an error code returned by UGW. In the case of this kind of error only, [Server detailed error] is displayed at the end of the error information. An internal error, such as Device internal memory unavailable, etc., error has occurred during a device internal error phase. Server schedule is During the communication test, there has been invalid some kind of error in the schedule values passed from UGW. Server response Due to network congestion, etc., the response from time out UGW does not come within the specified time. (HTTPS level time out)
Try again after a period of time and also check detailed error code (hexadecimal) from UGW displayed after the message.
Switch the device power OFF/ ON or replace the device system software. (Upgrade) When the error occurs, report the details to the support section, then, after the UGW side has responded, try the communication test again. If this error occurs when the communication test is being run, wait some time and run the test again.
Technology > Embedded RDS > Troubleshooting > Error code and strings
2-80
2
No. Code
Technology > Embedded RDS > Troubleshooting > Error code and strings
2-81
Error character strings 28 xxxx SUSPEND: xxxx Initialize Failure! 29 8300 SRAM version 0306 unmatched! No. Code Causes Remedy
Turn the device power OFF/ ON. Turn the device power OFF/ ON.
Error character Causes strings 19 8xxx Service not found There is a mistake in the UGW URL, and UGW 2048
cannot be accessed. (Path is wrong) A communication test has been attempted with the E-RDS switch being OFF
Remedy
Check that the value of Service mode > Function > Install > RGW-ADDRESS can be https://a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/ agentif010 Set Service mode > #E-RDS > E-RDS SWITCH to 1, and then run Service mode > Function > Install > COMTEST. Check the device settings status with the UGW administrator. Check the network connection, as per the troubleshooting initial procedures. Run Service mode > #E-RDS > COMTEST about 60 seconds after turn on the device.
Blank schedule data have been received from UGW. Communication attempted without confirming network connection, just after booting up a device in which the network preparations are not ready. (Network connection not established within 60 seconds of device boot up.) The data which is not URL Check Servicemode > #E-RDS is inputted into URL field. RGW-ADDRESS can be https://a01. ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif010. If not, enter the correct URL strings in URL description field.. Server address name resolution has failed. Communication test has not completed Check Servicemode > #E-RDS > RGW-ADDRESS can be https://a01. ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif010. Perform and complete a communication test.
Internal error occurred at the initiating E-RDS. Improper value is written in at the head of SRAM domain of E-RDS. 30 8xxx Device is busy, try The semaphore consumption error at the 0304 later time of a communication test. 31 8xxx Internal Schedule The schedule data in the inside of E-RDS is not 0207 is broken right. -
*1. [Hexadecimal ] indicates an error code returned from UGW. [Error strings]: indicates error details returned from UGW.
24 8xxx Server address 200B resolution error 25 0xxx Communication 0003 test is not performed 26 8xxx Server specified 0221 list is too big
Alert filtering error: The The number of elements of alert number of elements of the filtering is specified correctly. list specified by the server is over restriction value. Alert filtering error: Unjust The element of alert filtering is value is included in the specified with the right value. element of the list specified by the server.
Technology > Embedded RDS > Troubleshooting > Error code and strings
2-81
2-82
Com-Log Report
The report output of the communication error logging information on five affairs can be carried out. #REPORT > #REPORT OUTPUT > ERDS COM LOG LIST Output sample 01/17 2009 10:14 **************************** *** E-RDS-COM-LOG *** ****************************
Service cautions
After performing the following service activities it is necessary to perform Service mode #CLEAR > ERDS-DAT and #E-RDS. Failure to do so will result that the counter transmitting value to the UGW may become unusual. System upgrade HDD format and system installation COPIER > Function > Clear > MN-CONT Also, after replacing the main controller board, all settings must be reprogrammed. The following settings in service mode must not be change unless there are specific instructions to do so. Changing these values will cause error in communication with UGW. Service mode
#E-RDS > RGW-PORT #E-RDS > RGW-ADDRESS
No.01 DATE 05 18 2009 TIME 03:21 CODE 05000003 Information SUSPEND: Communication test is not performed. No.02 DATE 05 18 2009 TIME 03:21 CODE 00000000 Information SUNSEND: mode changed. No.03 DATE 05 18 2009 TIME 03:18 CODE 05000003 Information SUSPEND: Communication test is not performed. No.04 DATE 05 18 2009 TIME 03:18 CODE 00000000 Information SUNSEND: mode changed. No.05 DATE 05 18 2009 TIME 01:56 CODE 05000003 Information SUSPEND: Communication test is not performed.
Default
443 https://a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif010
T-2-45
2-82
Periodical Service
Consumable Parts and Cleaning Parts
Periodical Service
3-2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Image Waste toner container formation system Transfer guide Transfer roller Separation static charge eliminator Developing Assembly Fixing Fixing inlet guide system Fixing unit
FM3-9276 FC9-0693 FM3-9296 FM3-9263 120V for US: FM4-3367 120V for TW: FM4-8443 230V for KR/EU: FM3-9381 230V for except for KR/EU: FM48445
1 1 1 1 1 1 1
80,000 sheets 120,000 sheets 240,000 sheets 240,000 sheets 500,000 sheets 120,000 sheets 150,000 sheets
DRBL-1
WST-TNR Defined by 6% document TR-ROLL SP-SC-EL DVG-CYL FX-UNIT Wipe with dry cloth. If dirt cannot come off, wipe it with alcohol. Wipe with dry cloth.
3-2
3
No. System
3-3
Qty Life Interval Counter of consumables Remarks Reference
Items
Parts No. iR2530/2525 iR2530/2525/2520 (550-sheet 1st (250-sheet 1st cassette type) cassette type)
Pickup Cassette pickup roller feed (For 550-sheet cassette) system Cassette feed roller (For 550-sheet cassette) Cassette separation roller (For 550-sheet cassette) Cassette idler gear (Only for 550-sheet cassette for China) Cassette pickup roller (For 250-sheet cassette) Cassette separation pad (For 250-sheet cassette) Manual feed pickup roller Manual feed separation pad
*1or 2
120,000 sheets
DRBL-1
10
*1or 2
120,000 sheets
DRBL-1
11
FC6-6661
*1or 2
120,000 sheets
DRBL-1
12
FU3-0280
*1or 2
120,000 sheets 150,000 sheets 150,000 sheets 150,000 sheets 150,000 sheets
DRBL-1
C1-PU-RL, *: Quantity indicates number of C2-PU-RL, 550 sheets cassette. C3-PU-RL, C4-PU-RL Replace with cassette separation pad. *: Quantity indicates number of 550 sheets cassette. C1-SP-RL, *: Quantity indicates number of C2-SP-RL, 550 sheets cassette. C3-SP-RL, C4-SP-RL *: Quantity indicates number of 550 sheets cassette. C1-PU-RL C1-SP-PD M-PU-RL M-SP-PD
p. 4-42
p. 4-42
p. 4-43
p. 4-43
13 14 15 16
1 1 1 1
3-3
3-4
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] Transfer roller Separation static eliminator Waste toner container Drum unit Developing assembly Manual feed pickup roller Manual feed separation pad Fixing unit Cassette pickup roller (250-sheet 1st cassette model) Cassette separation pad (250-sheet 1st cassette model) Cassette pickup roller (550-sheet 1st cassette model) Cassette feed roller (550-sheet 1st cassette model) Cassette separation roller (550-sheet 1st cassette model) Idler gear (for China)
[1]
[2]
[6] [4]
[7] [8]
[14]
[12] [13]
[11] [9]
F-3-1
3-4
3-5
Cleaning Parts
Fixing guide
Transfer guide
F-3-2
3-5
4
List of Parts
List of Covers
[2]
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Covers
4-2
Symbol
[1] [2] [3] [4]
Part name
Reader Left Cover DADF (Optional or Standard) Reader Front Cover Control Panel
Part number
Reference
p. 4-14 p. 4-14 -
[3]
[1]
[4]
FC9-1641 FC9-1748 FM3-9356 (TW) FM3-9354 (UL,AU) FM3-9355 (CN) FM3-9357 (KR) FM3-9358 (EUR) Support Cover Delivery Tray FC9-0513 Front Cover FM3-9256 Cassette 1 Cassette 2 (Only for the Cassette 2 standard model) Lower Left Cover 550-sheet 1st cassette type: FC90506 250-sheet 1st cassette type : FC91001 Left Cover FM3-9338 Inside Base Cover FC9-0520 Rear Left Cover FC9-0523 Toner Supply Cover FC9-0571,FC9-0568
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Covers
4-2
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Covers
4-3
Symbol
[15] [16]
Part name
Reader Right Cover Platen Glass
Part number
FC9-1640 AB/INCH SIZE: FL3-3143 A/INCH SIZE: FL3-3190 A SIZE: FL3-3191 AB SIZE: FL3-3155 FC9-1749 FC9-0525 FC9-0524 FC9-0572 550-sheet 1st cassette type : FC90527 250-sheet 1st cassette type : FC91008-000 FM3-9285 FM3-9284 (With No.2 Deleivery Unit) FM3-9380 (Without No.2 Deleivery Unit) 550-sheet 1st cassette type: FC90507 250-sheet 1st cassette type: FC91002 FC9-4682
Reference
p. 4-20 p. 4-20
Reader Rear Cover Rear Cover (Right) Rear Cover (Left) Right Cover (Upper Rear) Right Cover (Lower Rear)
[18]
[22] [23]
p. 4-24
[24]
p. 4-22
[25]
p. 4-23
T-4-2
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Covers
4-3
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Main Units / Parts
4-4
Symbol
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7]
Part name
Right Cover Assembly Casstte Pickup Assembly Laser Scanner Unit Toner Supply Assembly CIS Unit No.2 Deleivery Assembly Platen Glass
Part number
FM3-9284 (With No.2 Deleivery Unit) FM3-9380 (Without No.2 Deleivery Unit) FM3-9372 FM3-9406 FM3-9428 FM3-9430 FM3-9314 AB/INCH SIZE: FL3-3143 A/INCH SIZE: FL3-3190 A SIZE: FL3-3191 AB SIZE: FL3-3155 FL3-3144 FM3-9354 (UL, AU) FM3-9358 (EU) FM3-9285
Reference
p. 4-24 p. 4-26 p. 4-27 p. 4-28 p. 4-29 p. 4-31 p. 4-32
[5]
[1]
[4]
[10]
[3] [8]
F-4-3
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Main Units / Parts
4-4
4
List of PCBs
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of PCBs
4-5
Symbol
PCB1 PCB5d PCB5c PCB2 PCB3
Part name
Main Controller PCB -
Main unit
Part number
iR2520: FM4-6215 iR2525: FM4-6216 iR2530 :FM4-6217 FM4-2860 550-sheet 1st cassette type, 120V: FM4-4195 550-sheet 1st cassette type, 230V: FM3-9258 250-sheet 1st cassette type, 120V: FM4-3374 250-sheet 1st cassette type, 230V: FM3-9361 550-sheet 1st cassette type: FM4-2864 250-sheet 1st cassette type: FM4-2865 FL3-3204 FM2-2753 FM4-2854 FM4-2855
Reference
p. 4-44
PCB5a PCB5b
p. 4-44 p. 4-45
PCB18
DC Controller PCB -
p. 4-45
PCB5a LCD Unit PCB5b PCB5c PCB5d PCB6 PCB7 PCB3 PCB12 PCB10 PCB10
PCB14
PCB11 PCB7
Control Panel Assembly 1/4 Inverter PCB Control Panel Assembly Control Panel CPU Control Panel PCB Assembly Key Top PCB Control Panel Assembly Assembly HVT PCB Option Power Supply PCB Heater PCB -
PCB11 NCU PCB PCB12 Modular PCB PCB13 PCB14 PCB15 PCB16 Pseudo-CI PCB Laser Driver PCB BD PCB RAM PCB
FM4-2872 120V: FK2-9187 230V: FK2-9188 120V: FM4-2857 230V: FM4-2858 FAX Assembly FM4-3344 (Except for TWN) FM4-3345 (TWN) FAX Assembly FM4-3347 (120V) FM4-3348 (230V) FAX Assembly FM2-2765 Laser Scanner Unit FM3-9406 Laser Scanner Unit FM3-9406 Main Controller PCB 256MB: FM4-3349 512MB: FM4-3350 Main Controller PCB FM4-3341 (Except for CHN) FM4-3342 (CHN) FM4-2886
T-4-4
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of PCBs
4-5
4
List of Solenoids
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Solenoids
4-6
Symbol
SL1 SL2 SL3 SL4 SL5 SL3
Part name
Pickup Solenoid
Main unit
Part number
Reference
-
Casstte Pickup FK2-0408 Assembly Manual Feed Pickup Solenoid Multi Pick-up Assembly FK2-1410 No. 1 Delivery Reversal FK2-9195 Solenoid Reversal Solenoid No.2 Deleivery FH6-5095 Assembly No. 2 Delivery Solenoid No.2 Deleivery FL3-3151 Assembly
T-4-5
SL5
SL4
SL2
SL1
F-4-5
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Solenoids
4-6
4
List of Sensors
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Sensors
4-7
S36 S36 (A/INCH) (AB/INCH) S37 S12 S33 S32 S31 S41 S42 S34 S35 S40
S11
S9 TS2 S8
S7
S5
F-4-6
F-4-7
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Sensors
4-7
4
Symbol
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Sensors
4-8
Part name iR2530/2525 iR2530/2525/2520 (550-sheet 1st (250-sheet 1st cassette type) cassette type)
Cassette 1 Pickup Sensor Cassette 1 Paper Sensor -
Main unit
Part number
Reference
S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 S9 S11 S12 S16 S17 S18 S19 S31 S32 S33 S34 S35 S36 S37 S40 S41 S42 HU1 TS1 TS2
Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor A Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor B Pre-Registration Sensor Loop Sensor Duplex Feed Sensor Manual Feeder Paper Size Sensor Manual Feeder Paper Sensor No.1 Delivery Full Sensor No.1 Delivery Sensor Toner Cover Open/Closed Sensor Waste Toner Full Sensor Front Cover Open/Closed Sensor Fixing Outlet Sensor CIS Hp Sensor Copyboard Cover Open/Closed Sensor 0 Copyboard Cover Open/Closed Sensor 1 Original Size Sensor 0 Original Size Sensor 1 Original Size Sensor 2 Original Size Sensor 3 Reversal Sensor No. 2 Delivery Full Sensor No. 2 Delivery Sensor Enviorment Sensor Developing Unit Toner Sensor Sub Hopper Toner Sensor
Casstte Pickup Assembly Casstte Pickup Assembly Cassette pickup assembly Cassette pickup assembly Multi Pick-up Assembly Multi Pick-up Assembly Fixing Assembly No.2 Deleivery Assembly No.2 Deleivery Assembly No.2 Deleivery Assembly Developing Assembly Developing Assembly
WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5696 WG8-5696 WG8-5696 FH7-7569 FH7-7569 FH7-7569 FH7-7569 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WG8-5836 WP2-5264 WP2-5282 WP2-5282
T-4-6
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Sensors
4-8
4
List of Motors
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Motors
4-9
Symbol
M1 M2 M3 M6 M7 M10 M10 M2 M1 M31
Part name
Main Motor Fixing Motor Cassette 1 Pickup Motor Bottle Motor Hopper Motor Reversal Motor Scanner Motor
Main unit
Toner Supply Assembly Toner Supply Assembly No.2 Deleivery Assembly -
Part number
FK2-9141 FK2-9145 FK2-7327 FK2-9147 FK2-9147 FK2-9150 FK2-1066
Reference
p. 4-50 p. 4-53 p. 4-54 p. 4-55 T-4-7
M31
M6 M7 M3
F-4-8
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Motors
4-9
4
List of Fans
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Fans
4-10
Symbol
FAN3 FAN4 FAN6
Part name
Main unit
Part number
Reference
p. 4-56
T-4-8
Exhaust Fan (Rear) Right Cover Assembly FK2-0360 Exhaust Fan (Front) Right Cover Assembly FK2-0360 Power Supply Cooling Fan FK2-0360
FAN3
FAN4
FAN6
F-4-9
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Fans
4-10
4
List of Switches
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Switches
4-11
Symbol
SW2 SW4 SW6 SW7
Part name
Front Door Switch Enviorment Switch Cassette Size Detection Switch 1 Cassette Size Detection Switch 2 -
Main unit
Part number
WC4-5242 FM4-2876 WC2-5680 WC2-5680
Reference
p. 4-57 p. 4-58 p. 4-58
T-4-9
SW2
SW4 SW6
SW7
F-4-10
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Switches
4-11
4
List of Clutches
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Clutches
4-12
Symbol
Part name iR2530/2525 iR2530/2525/2520 (550-sheet 1st (250-sheet 1st cassette cassette type) type)
Registration Clutch Manual Feed Cassette / Manual Pickup Clutch Feed Pickup Clutch Developing Cylinder Clutch Duplex Feed Clutch
Main unit
Part number
Reference
F-4-11
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > List of Parts > List of Clutches
4-12
4
Other
4-13
Symbol
[1] [2] TH1 TH2 H1 H2 SP1 H3 H4 H5 [1] TH1 TH2 H1 H2 SP1 H4 [2]
Part name
Fixing Main Thermistor Fixing Sub Thermistor Fixing Heater 1 Fixing Heater 2 Speaker (Option) Cassette Heater (Option) Drum Heater (Option) Reader Heater (Option) Fixing Film Unit
Main unit
Fixing Assembly Fixing Assembly Fixing Assembly Fixing Assembly
Part number
Reference
p. 4-61
H6
H5
Pressure Roller
120V for US: FM4-3367 120V for TW: FM4-8443 230V for KR/EU: FM39381 230V for except for KR/ EU: FM4-8445 FK2-9442 FM3-8915 FK2-9157 120V: FK2-9468 230V: FK2-0228 Fixing Assembly 120V for US: FM4-3368 120V for TW: FM4-8444 230V for KR/EU: FM39382 230V for except for KR/ EU: FM4-8446 Fixing Assembly FC7-0242
p. 4-66
T-4-11
H3
F-4-12
4-13
4
External Covers
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Support Cover
4-14
x2
F-4-13
x2 x2
x2
F-4-15
F-4-14
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Support Cover
4-14
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Front Cover
4-15
x3
x2
F-4-18 F-4-16
x1
F-4-19 F-4-17
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Front Cover
4-15
4
1) Remove the cassette. 2) Remove the lower left cover.
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Left Cover
4-16
x2
x1
Rod
F-4-20
x3
The left cover has a rod interlocked with the switch on the power supply PCB. Remove the left cover without applying load on it.
Claw
F-4-21
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Left Cover
4-16
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Inside Base Cover
4-17
MEMO: When reassembling the left cover, insert the rod of the left cover switch into the main power switch securely.
x1
x2
x1
F-4-23
F-4-24
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Inside Base Cover
4-17
4
1) Install the inside base cover. 2) Secure it with one screw.
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Left Rear Cover
4-18
F-4-26
x3
x1
x3
F-4-25 F-4-27
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Left Rear Cover
4-18
4
1) Open the front cover.
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Toner Supply Cover
4-19
7) Open the toner supply cover. 8) Remove the toner supply cover. 2 screws (RS tightening; M3) 1 claw
x2 x1
x1
F-4-28
Claw
F-4-30
F-4-29
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Toner Supply Cover
4-19
4
<For iR 2530/2525/2520>
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Reader Rear Cover
4-20
x5
x2
F-4-31
F-4-33
x2 x2
F-4-32 F-4-34
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Reader Rear Cover
4-20
4
3 connectors 1 screw (RS tightening; M3)
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Rear Cover (Right)
4-21
x3 x1 x1
F-4-35
4) Remove the reader rear cover. 4 screws (RS tightening; M3) 1 claw
F-4-37
x4
Claw
x3 x2
Claws
F-4-38
F-4-36
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Rear Cover (Right)
4-21
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Lower Rear Cover
4-22
Claw
Claw
x2
Claws
x2
F-4-41 F-4-39
x1 x2
F-4-42 F-4-40
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Lower Rear Cover
4-22
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Cassette 2 Rear Cover
4-23
2) Disconnect all connectors (only for the machine with an optional cassette).
F-4-43
3) Remove the lower rear cover. 1 screw (RS tightening; M3) 1 claw
x1 x1
Claw
F-4-44
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > External Covers > Removing the Cassette 2 Rear Cover
4-23
4
Main Units/Parts
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Right Cover Assembly
4-24
x1
x1
F-4-46
F-4-45
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Right Cover Assembly
4-24
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Right Cover Assembly
4-25
7) Remove the connection cable. 2 connectors (The machine without the No.2 delivery unit does not have the upper connector.) CAUTION: Be sure to disconnect the upper connector after releasing the harness from the clamp to prevent breaking of wire.
x2
F-4-49
x1
F-4-47
x2
F-4-48
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Right Cover Assembly
4-25
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st Cassette Model)
4-26
7) Remove the link between the right cover and cassette pickup assembly. 8) Remove the cassette pickup assembly. 4 screws (RS tightening; M3)
x4
x1
F-4-51
F-4-50
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Cassette Pickup Assembly (550-sheet 1st Cassette Model)
4-26
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette Model)
4-27
F-4-53
x1
x1
F-4-52
F-4-54
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Cassette Pickup Assembly (250-sheet 1st cassette Model)
4-27
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit
4-28
11) Remove the link between the right cover and cassette pickup assembly. 12) Remove the cassette pickup assembly. 3 screws
x3
x2
F-4-55
x1
F-4-57
CAUTION: When pulling out the laser scanner, take care not to touch the PCB installed on the laser scanner unit. (The PCB is equipped with a laser intensity adjusting volume resistor and so touching the PCB can change the adjustment setting.)
F-4-56
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit
4-28
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Toner Supply Unit
4-29
SW No.
145
146
147
136 148
149
150
F-4-58
PRINT > Bitswitch > 136 Laser horizontal scanning direction write position adjustment(A) PRINT > Bitswitch > 145 Laser horizontal scanning direction magnification ratio adjustment(A-B) PRINT > Bitswitch > 146 Laser horizontal scanning direction magnification ratio adjustment(A-C) PRINT > Bitswitch > 147 Laser horizontal scanning direction magnification ratio adjustment(A-D) PRINT > Bitswitch > 148 Laser horizontal scanning direction write position adjustment(A-B) PRINT > Bitswitch > 149 Laser horizontal scanning direction write position adjustment(A-C) PRINT > Bitswitch > 150 Laser horizontal scanning direction write position adjustment(A-D)
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Toner Supply Unit
4-29
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Toner Supply Unit > Action to Take after Replacement
4-30
x2 x4
1 parallel pin
F-4-60
x1 x1
F-4-59
F-4-61
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Toner Supply Unit > Action to Take after Replacement
4-30
4
3)Remove the bottle ring.
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the CIS Unit
4-31
F-4-62
F-4-64
CAUTION: When installing or removing the contact sensor unit, do not touch the light guide and rod lens array.
F-4-65 F-4-63
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the CIS Unit
4-31
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Platen Glass
4-32
x2
1) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the platen glass, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DFWLVL1. Read the white level in the BOOK mode. (Check the transparency of the glass for BOOK mode.) 2) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the DF, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2. Read the white level in the DF mode (stream reading). (Check the transparency of the glass for stream reading.)(Read both sides of the chart.) 3) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the platen glass, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DFWLVL3. Read the white level in the BOOK mode. (Check the transparency of the glass for BOOK mode.) 4) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the DF, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4. Read the white level in the DF mode (stream reading). (Check the transparency of the glass for stream reading.)(Read both sides of the chart.)
F-4-67
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Platen Glass
4-32
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the ADF Scan Glass
4-33
W-PLT-X
W-PLT-Y
W-PLT-Z
F-4-68
x2
1.Enter the value indicated on the platen glass in the following service mode: SCAN > READER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-X/Y/Z (Input of standard white plate data) 2.Enter the service mode, and then select the following: SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1/2/3/4 (DF white level adjustment) 1) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the platen glass, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DFWLVL1. Read the white level in the BOOK mode. (Check the transparency of the glass for BOOK mode.) 2) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the DF, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2. Read the white level in the DF mode (stream reading). (Check the transparency of the glass for stream reading.)(Read both sides of the chart.) 3) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the platen glass, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DFWLVL3. Read the white level in the BOOK mode. (Check the transparency of the glass for BOOK mode.) 4) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the DF, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4. Read the white level in the DF mode (stream reading). (Check the transparency of the glass for stream reading.)(Read both sides of the chart.)
F-4-69
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the ADF Scan Glass
4-33
4
CAUTION:
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Control Panel Assembly
4-34
3) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the platen glass, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DFWLVL3. Read the white level in the BOOK mode. (Check the transparency of the glass for BOOK mode.) 4) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the DF, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4. Read the white level in the DF mode (stream reading). (Check the transparency of the glass for stream reading.)(Read both sides of the chart.)
When removing the ADF scan glass, take care not to touch the glass surface with your fingers. Soils on the glass surface may cause white/black lines on images. If the glass surface is soiled, clean them with a lint-free paper moistened with alcohol. Be sure to install the ADF scan glass with its seat facing front left.
x2 x1
F-4-70
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Control Panel Assembly
4-34
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Multi Pickup Assembly
4-35
x2
F-4-73
x1 x4
F-4-72
F-4-74
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Multi Pickup Assembly
4-35
4
4 screws
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Multi Pickup Assembly
4-36
x4
F-4-75
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Main Units/Parts > Removing the Multi Pickup Assembly
4-36
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Waste Toner Container
4-37
x1
x1
F-4-78
1) Open the front cover. 2) Turn the lock lever as shown to release the lock of the waste toner container.
F-4-79
F-4-77
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Waste Toner Container
4-37
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Drum Unit
4-38
F-4-80
x1
4) Remove the lid attached at the front of the waste toner container, and then cover the opening of the container with it so that the waste toner does not spill out.
F-4-82
6) While raising the lever under the handle of the drum unit, slowly pull out the drum unit to the position shown below.
F-4-81
F-4-83
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Drum Unit
4-38
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Manual Feed Pickup Roller
4-39
CAUTION: When installing the toner supply unit, insert a guide of the developing unit to the ditch of the host machine.
F-4-84
Guide
F-4-86
x1 x1
F-4-87
F-4-85
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Manual Feed Pickup Roller
4-39
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Manual Feed Separation Pad
4-40
2) Release the claws, and then slide the bearing (front). 3) Remove the manual feed pickup roller.
x1
x1
Claw
F-4-88
MEMO: Reassemble the manual feed pickup roller as shown. 3) Remove the separation pad with a flat-blade screwdriver.
F-4-90
F-4-89 F-4-91
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Manual Feed Separation Pad
4-40
4
1) Open the right cover 2) Remove the fixing unit. - 2 screws
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller (250-sheet 1st cassette Model)
4-41
x2 x1
F-4-92
Claw
F-4-94
F-4-93 F-4-95
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller (250-sheet 1st cassette Model)
4-41
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Cassette Feed Roller (550-sheet 1st cassette Model)
4-42
Removing the Roller Cassette Separation Pad (250-sheet 1st cassette Model)
1) Remove the cassette from the main unit. 2) Remove the cassette separation pad with a flat-blade screwdriver.
x1
F-4-97
x1
F-4-96
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Cassette Feed Roller (550-sheet 1st cassette Model)
4-42
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Idler Gear (Only for 550-sheet 1st cassette Model for China)
4-43
x1
x1
F-4-100
F-4-99
Removing the Idler Gear (Only for 550-sheet 1st cassette Model for China)
1) Draw out the cassette from the main unit. 2) Open the right cover. 3) Remove the cassette pickup roller. (Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller (550-sheet 1st cassette Model)(page 4-42). ) 4) Remove the cassette feed roller. (Removing the Cassette Feed Roller (550-sheet 1st cassette Model)(page 4-42).) 5) Remove the idler gear. - 1 claw
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > Consumable Parts Requiring Periodic Replacement > Removing the Idler Gear (Only for 550-sheet 1st cassette Model for China)
4-43
4
PCB
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Reader Relay PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-44
x7 x6
x11
F-4-102
F-4-101
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Reader Relay PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-44
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the DC Controller PCB > Action to Take after Replacement/RAM Clearing
4-45
Replacement Procedure
1) Remove the rear cover (right). (Removing the Rear Cover (Right)(page 4-21)..) 2) Remove the rear cover (left). (Removing the Rear Cover (Left)(page 4-22)..) 3) Disconnect all connectors on the DC controller PCB. 4) Remove the DC controller PCB. - 6 screws (Screw A is tightened together with the earth cable.)
x3
x6
F-4-103
F-4-104
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the DC Controller PCB > Action to Take after Replacement/RAM Clearing
4-45
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Option Power Supply PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-46
x2 x1 x2 x1
F-4-106 F-4-105
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Option Power Supply PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-46
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Heater PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-47
5) Disconnect all connectors on the option power supply PCB. 6) Remove the option power supply PCB. - 2 screws
x1
3) Disconnect all connectors on the heater PCB. 4) Remove the heater PCB. - 1 screw
x1
F-4-108
x1
F-4-107
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Heater PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-47
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the RAM PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-48
3) For the model with a FAX and SEND function, press the SW3 on the main controller to check that LED10 goes out. (Secondary power cutoff)
x3
F-4-109
F-4-110
CAUTION: The ADRAM is powered from the secondary battery unit to back up the image memory even after the main power switch is turned OFF and the power plug is removed from the outlet. If the SW3 on the main controller PCB is pressed with the image backed up, the entire data stored in the memory is cleared. Be sure to output the data stored in the memory before pressing the SW3.
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the RAM PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-48
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the RAM PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-49
F-4-111
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the RAM PCB > Replacement Procedure
4-49
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > No. 1 Delivery Reversal Solenoid (SL3) > Replacement Procedure
4-50
x1
x1
F-4-114
NOTE: When reinstalling the No.1 deleivery unit, insert the positioning boss in the hole.
F-4-112
Hole
Boss
F-4-115
F-4-113
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > No. 1 Delivery Reversal Solenoid (SL3) > Replacement Procedure
4-50
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > No. 1 Delivery Reversal Solenoid (SL3) > Replacement Procedure
4-51
5) Remove the rear cover (right).(Removing the Rear Cover (Right)(page 4-21).) 6) Remove the rear cover (left).(Removing the Rear Cover (Left)(page 4-22).) 7) Remove the right cover (upper rear).(Removing the Rear Right Cover (Upper)(page 4-22).) 8) Remove the support plate. 9) Disconnect all connectors on the DC controller PCB.(Removing the DC Controller PCB(page 4-45).) 10) 1 claw Remove the gear.
11)
- 3 screws
x3
F-4-117
F-4-116
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > No. 1 Delivery Reversal Solenoid (SL3) > Replacement Procedure
4-51
4
12) - 3 screws - 1 connector
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > No. 1 Delivery Reversal Solenoid (SL3) > Replacement Procedure
4-52
x1
F-4-118
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > No. 1 Delivery Reversal Solenoid (SL3) > Replacement Procedure
4-52
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Fixing Motor (M2) > Replacement Procedure
4-53
x1 x4
x1 x1
F-4-119
NOTE: Because there is a screw on the backside of the relay connector, remove the relay connector earlier.
F-4-120
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Fixing Motor (M2) > Replacement Procedure
4-53
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Cassette 1 Pickup Motor (M3) > Replacement Procedure
4-54
5) Disconnect all connectors on the DC controller PCB. 6) Remove the DC controller PCB assembly. - 3 screws
x1 x4
F-4-122
x1 x4
F-4-121
F-4-123
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Cassette 1 Pickup Motor (M3) > Replacement Procedure
4-54
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Scanner Motor (M31) > Replacement Procedure
4-55
x1 x2
[4]
[1]
[2] [3]
5) Remove the scanner motor. - 4 screws
[2]
F-4-125
F-4-124
F-4-126
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Scanner Motor (M31) > Replacement Procedure
4-55
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Power Supply Cooling Fan (FAN6) > Replacement Procedure
4-56
x2 x1
F-4-127
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Power Supply Cooling Fan (FAN6) > Replacement Procedure
4-56
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Front Door Switch (SW2) > Replacement Procedure
4-57
x1
F-4-130
5) Remove the waste toner release lever. 6) Remove the internal cover (right). - 4 screws
CAUTION:
F-4-128
When reinstalling the box tray, installation so that the positioning boss is satisfied in a spring.
x4
F-4-131
F-4-129
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Front Door Switch (SW2) > Replacement Procedure
4-57
4
- 2 screws
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Cassette Size Detection Switch (SW6/SW7) > Replacement Procedure
4-58
x2
x1 x1
x1
F-4-133
F-4-134
NOTE: Remove the connector and the screw from the rear, but the cassette size detection assembly removes it from the front side.
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Cassette Size Detection Switch (SW6/SW7) > Replacement Procedure
4-58
4
- 1 connector - 1 screw - 2 claws
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Cassette Size Detection Switch (SW6/SW7) > Replacement Procedure
4-59
SW6 x2
SW7
x1 x1
F-4-135
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Cassette Size Detection Switch (SW6/SW7) > Replacement Procedure
4-59
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Clutch (CL1/CL2/CL3/CL4) > Replacement Procedure
4-60
CL4 CL2
x1 x3
CL3
CL1
F-4-137
F-4-136
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > PCB > Removing the Clutch (CL1/CL2/CL3/CL4) > Replacement Procedure
4-60
4
OTHER
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-61
CAUTION: When installing the left side plate, install it to engage the teeth with the locking lever at the position shown in the figure.
x1
F-4-140
F-4-138
x3 x1
F-4-141
F-4-139
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-61
4
6) Remove the cable guide. - 1 boss
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-62
x1
F-4-142
F-4-144
x3
F-4-143
F-4-145
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-62
4
10) Remove the 2 screws.
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-63
x1
x1
x1
F-4-148 F-4-146
CAUTION: Never turn the screw (arrow part) pressurizing the fixing assembly. Turning this screw causes to change the pressure of the fixing assembly and results in the replacement of the fixing assembly because the pressure adjustment cannot be performed in the field.
x1 x1
11) Turn the pressure unit and release the pressure unit.
F-4-149
F-4-147
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-63
4
- 1 screw - 1 connector
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-64
x1 x1
F-4-152
x2
F-4-153 F-4-151
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-64
4
- 1 screw - 1 connector
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-65
x1 x1
F-4-154
F-4-156
F-4-155
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Replacement Procedure
4-65
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Pressure Roller > Replacement Procedure
4-66
F-4-157
Parts Replacement and Cleaning > OTHER > Removing the Pressure Roller > Replacement Procedure
4-66
Adjustment
Outline Adjustment when replacing parts Image position adjustment
Adjustment
5
Outline
5-2
Left Image MarginSingle-sided copy: 2.5 1.5 (mm) Double-sided copy: 2.5 2.0 (mm) 2.5+/-1.5mm (2nd side of double-sided copy: 2.5+/-2.0mm)
0 2 4 5 6 8 10
Category
Item
Reference
Replacing parts
CIS Unit Copyboard glass ADF reading glass
Reference
Action to Take after Replacing the CIS Unit(page 5-3). Action to Take after Replacing the Platen Glass(page 5-3). Action to Take after Replacing the ADF Scan Glass(page 5-4). Action to Take after Replacing theMain Controller PCB(page 5-4). Refer to page 5-4 Action to Take after Replacing the RAM(page 5-5). Action to Take after Replacing the Laser Scanner Unit(page 5-5).
T-5-1
Controller System
Leading Edge Single-sided copy: 2.5 1.5 (mm) Non-Image Width Double-sided copy: 2.5 1.5 (mm) 2.5+/-1.5mm (2nd side of double-sided copy: 2.5+/-1.5mm)
Category
Item
Reference
456
8 10 12 14 16 18 20
Single-sided copy: 2.5 1.5 (mm) Double-sided copy: 2.5 1.5 (mm) 2.5+/-1.5mm (2nd side of double-sided copy: 2.5+/-1.5mm)
0 2 4 5 6 8 10
456
8 10 12 14 16 18 20
T-5-2
5-2
Adjustment > Adjustment when replacing parts > Scanning System > Action to Take after Replacing the Platen Glass
5-3
F-5-1
1.Enter the value indicated on the platen glass in the following service mode: SCAN > READER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-X/Y/Z (Input of standard white plate data) 2.Enter the service mode, and then select the following: SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1/2/3/4 (DF white level adjustment) 1) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the platen glass, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DFWLVL1. Read the white level in the BOOK mode. (Check the transparency of the glass for BOOK mode.) 2) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the DF, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2. Read the white level in the DF mode (stream reading). (Check the transparency of the glass for stream reading.)(Read both sides of the chart.) 3) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the platen glass, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DFWLVL3. Read the white level in the BOOK mode. (Check the transparency of the glass for BOOK mode.) 4) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the DF, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4. Read the white level in the DF mode (stream reading). (Check the transparency of the glass for stream reading.)(Read both sides of the chart.)
1) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the platen glass, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DFWLVL1. Read the white level in the BOOK mode. (Check the transparency of the glass for BOOK mode.) 2) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the DF, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2. Read the white level in the DF mode (stream reading). (Check the transparency of the glass for stream reading.)(Read both sides of the chart.) 3) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the platen glass, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DFWLVL3. Read the white level in the BOOK mode. (Check the transparency of the glass for BOOK mode.) 4) Place a sheet of paper that the user usually uses on the DF, enter the service mode, and then select SCAN > READER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4. Read the white level in the DF mode (stream reading). (Check the transparency of the
Adjustment > Adjustment when replacing parts > Scanning System > Action to Take after Replacing the Platen Glass
5-3
Adjustment > Adjustment when replacing parts > Controller System > Action to Take when Replacing the DC Controller PCB
5-4
Controller System
Action to Take after Replacing theMain Controller PCB
After replacing the main controller PCB with a new one, take the following action: Download the latest firmware with the UST. Enter all values recorded on the service label affixed to the rear cover.
Adjustment > Adjustment when replacing parts > Controller System > Action to Take when Replacing the DC Controller PCB
5-4
Adjustment > Adjustment when replacing parts > Laser Exposure System > Action to Take after Replacing the Laser Scanner Unit
5-5
SW No.
145
146
147
136 148
149
150
F-5-2
PRINT > Bitswitch > 136 Laser horizontal scanning direction write position adjustment(A) PRINT > Bitswitch > 145 Laser horizontal scanning direction magnification ratio adjustment(A-B) PRINT > Bitswitch > 146 Laser horizontal scanning direction magnification ratio adjustment(A-C) PRINT > Bitswitch > 147 Laser horizontal scanning direction magnification ratio adjustment(A-D) PRINT > Bitswitch > 148 Laser horizontal scanning direction write position adjustment(A-B) PRINT > Bitswitch > 149 Laser horizontal scanning direction write position adjustment(A-C) PRINT > Bitswitch > 150 Laser horizontal scanning direction write position adjustment(A-D)
Adjustment > Adjustment when replacing parts > Laser Exposure System > Action to Take after Replacing the Laser Scanner Unit
5-5
Adjustment > Image position adjustment > Leading Edge Non-Image Width
5-6
0 2 4 5 6 8 10
F-5-4
Increase the value. (an increase of '10' will increase the non-image width by 1 mm)
F-5-5
Adjustment > Image position adjustment > Leading Edge Non-Image Width
5-6
5
Left Non-Image Width
5-7
0 2 4 5 6 8 10
F-5-6
5-7
Troubleshooting
Initial Check Test Print Troubleshooting items Upgrading Targets and Procedure
Troubleshooting
6
Initial Check
Initial check items list
Item No. Detail
1 2 3 4 5 6 Checking the Paper Checking the Placement of Paper 1 2 1 2
6-2
Item No. Detail
1 2 3 4 5 6 Drive system 1 2 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 Check that there is no foreign particle such as paper dust etc. Check that the pickup/feed/separation roller does not accumulate the paper dust. Check that these rollers are not worn and deformed and have no cut/dirt. Check that the registration roller/paper path roller is not worn and deformed and has no cut/dirt. Check that the feed guide is not worn and deformed and has no cut/ dirt. Check that there is no edge fold/curl/wave/moisture absorption occurred on the paper. Check if using Canon recommended paper/transparency makes it better or not. Check that the drive system does not get heavy load. Check that the gear is not worn and not get chipped. Check that the cassette is installed properly and the paper size is configured properly. Check if the symptom appears or not after replacing the cassette with the cassette that works normally. Check that the cassette middle plate moves smoothly and is not deformed. Check that the cassette side guide plate/ trailing edge guide plate is properly set. Check that the cassette heater switch is ON (When the cassette heater is installed.). Check that the sensor/clutch/motor/solenoid works properly (Make sure to check the power source and signal transmission route with the general circuit diagram.). Check that there is no wire wedged/screw loosened. Check that all the external covers are installed. Check that the main power switch/control panel power switch is ON. Check that the wiring of power cable/signal cable to each option is properly installed. Check that the fuse on each PCB does not burn out. Check that there is no error in customer's usage method. If moving the machine from the cold place such as storage etc to a warm place abruptly, dew condensation is generated inside machine and it may cause various troubles. E100 occurs due to dew condensation on BD sensor. Low image density in the vertical scanning direction due to dew condensation on the dust-proof glass. Low image density due to dew condensation on the reader CCD and copyboard glass. Paper feed failure due to dew condensation on the pickup, feed guide. If the symptom d appears, wipe the pickup/feed unit with dry cloth. Moreover, if storing the toner container/developing assembly/drum unit in the cold place and unpacking them abruptly in warm place, dew condensation may be generated. To prevent dew condensation, place them in warm place sufficiently (for 1 to 2 hours) before unpacking.
T-6-2
Check
Check
Site Environment
The voltage of the power supply is as rated (+/-10%). The site is not a high temperature / humidity environment (near a water faucet, water boiler, humidifi er), and it is not in a cold place. The machine is not near a source of fi re or dust. The site is not subject to ammonium gas. The site is not exposed to direct rays of the sun. (Otherwise, provide curtains.) The site is well ventilated, and the floor keeps the machine level. The machine's power plug remains connected to the power outlet. The paper is of a recommended type. The paper is not moist. Try paper fresh out of package. Check the cassette and the manual feed tray to see if the paper is not in excess of a specific level. If a transparency is used, check to make sure that it is placed in the correct orientation in the manual feed tray. Check the table of durables to see if any has reached the end of its life. Check the scheduled servicing table and the periodically replaced parts table, and replace any part that has reached the time of replacement.
T-6-1
Cassette
General
Check
Others 2
6-2
6
Test Print
Overview
Troubleshooting > Test Print > Select the test print TYPE
6-3
This machine have the following test print TYPE and you can judge the image failure that is checked as Yes in the following image check items with each test print. If the image failure occurred on normal output does not reappear on the test print, it may be caused by the PDL input or reader side.
Right Angle
Straight Lines
SELECT NO.01 SELECT NO.02 SELECT NO.03 SELECT NO.04 SELECT NO.05 SELECT NO.06 SELECT NO.07 SELECT NO.08 SELECT NO.09
Grid Half-tone All-black ---(For R&D) ---(For R&D) 4dot-6space (vertical) 4dot-6space (horizontal) ---(For R&D) 16 gray levels (monochromatic) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
T-6-3
Procedure 1) Enter the PG number with numeric keys, then press the START key. 2) Select single-sided (SGL: 0) or double-sided (DBL: 1), then press the START key. 3) Enter the number of prints to be output (PG COUNT), then press the START key. 4) Specify the paper drawer (main unit), then press the START key. Main unit cassette (ST_C: 0), 2nd cassette (OP_C: 1), Manual feed tray (MLT: 2) 5) Specify the paper eject slot, then press the START key. Tray 1 (1_OUT: 0), Tray2 (2_OUT: 1) 6) Select a paper type, then press the OK key. Plain paper (PLN: 0), Thick paper (TCK: 1),Thin paper (OHP: 2) 7) A test pattern is output.
Troubleshooting > Test Print > Select the test print TYPE
6-3
6
Troubleshooting items
Troubleshooting items list
Category
Image failure Dirt Blur/Void Operation failure Paper jam
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting items > Image Faults > Stained Leading/Trailing Edge of Paper
6-4
[Cause] Fixing assembly: Toner came off the paper sticks to the pressure roller, and then the toner sticks to the reverse side of the paper. Transfer roller: Toner remained on the drum that had stopped at occurrence of a jam. During Item Reference
6-4 6-4 6-5 6-5 6-6 6-6
the recovery operation performed later, the toner sticks to the transfer roller. [Occurrence condition] Fixing assembly: When fixing ability is poor due to low temperature, a halftone image has been printed on a lot of sheets of paper, or the time for replacement of the transfer unit is near Transfer roller: When a paper jam has occurred or the time for replacement of the transfer roller is near. [Remedy] Fixing assembly: USER MODE> Adjustment/ Cleaning> Fixing Unit Cleaning
Paper reverse side stained with toner Stained leading/trailing edge of paper Image transfer wrong/text void Image deletion/blur/dew condensation Too large curl Thin paper jam (63g/cm2 or less)
Paper jam due to solid image printed on paper 6-6 with small leading-edge margin (1-4 mm) Cannot turn the toner bottle set lever or hard to 6-6 turn it 6-7 Abnormal noise during multi-feed operation
T-6-4
Image Faults
Paper Reverse Side Stained with Toner
F-6-2 F-6-1
[Occurrence area] Transfer front guide Fixing inlet guide [Cause] Transfer front guide: The leading or trailing edge of paper touches the toner stuck to the transfer front upper guide.
[Occurrence area] Fixing assembly (circumference of the roller: iR2545/2535; 94mm, iR2530/2525/2520; 78.5mm) Transfer roller (circumference: 50mm)
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting items > Image Faults > Stained Leading/Trailing Edge of Paper
6-4
6
inlet guide. [Occurrence condition]
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting items > Image Faults > Image Deletion/Blur/Dew Condensation
6-5
Fixing inlet guide: The leading or trailing edge of paper touches the toner stuck to the fixing
When halftone or solid-black images are printed in succession [Remedy] Using lens-cleaning paper or the like, clean the guide stained with toner.
F-6-3
[Occurrence area] Drum (circumference: 94mm) [Cause] Corona products generated on the charging roller stick to the drum, and then water molecules adsorb onto them, resulting in reduction in resistance. Therefore, a desired latent image cannot be formed, resulting in a blurred image. [Occurrence area] Transfer roller (circumference: 50mm) [Cause] Resistance of paper increases due to reduction in paper water content, resulting in insufficient transfer output. Resistance of paper decreases due to increase in paper water content, resulting in excessive transfer output. [Occurrence condition] Paper left alone in a low-humidity environment Paper left alone in a high-humidity environment [Remedy] [Occurrence condition] When the machine is operated first in the morning under the high-temperature and highhumidity environment. [Remedy] USER MODE> Adjustment/ Cleaning> Special Mode F> Low, Meduium, or High Install the optional drum heater.
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting items > Image Faults > Image Deletion/Blur/Dew Condensation
6-5
6
Too Large Curl
[Occurrence area] Fixing assembly [Cause]
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting items > Image Faults > Cannot Turn the Toner Bottle Set Lever or Hard to Turn it
6-6
Paper Jam due to Solid Image Printed on Paper with Small Leading-Edge Margin (1-4 mm)
[Occurrence area] Fixing assembly [Cause] When a solid image is printed on the paper with a small leading-edge margin (1-4 mm), paper cannot be easily separated from the fixing film, causing a paper jam. [Occurrence condition] When the paper has been left alone in a high-humidity environment or when a solid image is printed on the paper with a small leading-edge margin. [Remedy] USER MODE> Adjustment/ Cleaning> Manual> Special Mode O> Medium or High USER MODE> Adjustment/ Cleaning> Manual> Special Mode N> High *Selecting "Special Mode O" or "Special Mode N>High" will increase the leading-edge margin and consequently prevent a paper jam due to improper separation. *Selecting "Special Mode N>High" will make the curl smaller but reduce the productivity.
The water content on the front surface of paper becomes different from that on the reverse side of paper, making the curl larger. [Occurrence condition] When the paper has been left alone in a high-humidity environment. [Remedy] USER MODE> Adjustment/ Cleaning> Manual> Special Mode N> Medium or High *Normally, select "Low". Selecting "High" will reduce productivity. Machine shipped with cassette heater: Turn on the heater. Install an optional cassette heater.
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting items > Image Faults > Cannot Turn the Toner Bottle Set Lever or Hard to Turn it
6-6
6
[Occurrence area] Gear of right cover unit [Cause]
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting items > Image Faults > Abnormal Noise During Multi-Feed Peration
6-7
Escape hole
When the right cover unit is closed, the belt cannot enter the clearance groove depending on the lower belt securing position and therefore the belt is Z-folded. As a result, the right cover unit is pushed out and consequently the gear on the right cover unit side meshes with the gear on the host machine side loosely, generating abnormal noise. [Occurrence condition] When the belt of the right cover unit is reinstalled [Remedy] Secure the belt to the right cover unit in such a manner that it does not turn along with the screw (i.e., it is secured horizontally or it faces slightly down).
F-6-4
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting items > Image Faults > Abnormal Noise During Multi-Feed Peration
6-7
6-8
Target system software File type Remarks
Host machine
Target Category PCB iR2545/iR2535 Main controller PCB
Boot USTUPDATE_iR2545_35_ There are two types BOOT_vXXXX of main controllers. USTUPDATE_iR2545_35_ Note: When upgrading bootable_lang_WLaaXXXX two types of firmware, USTUPDATE_ Boot and Bootable iR2530_25_20_BOOT_ lang, at the same time, vXXXX upgrade Boot first. USTUPDATE_ iR2530_25_20_bootable_ lang_WLaaXXXX
Program
Host machine Main controller PCB Flash ROM CPU USB cable J8104
PC iR2545/iR2535 DC controller iR2530/2525 PCB UST or SST System software RS232C straight cable Downloader PCB FY9-2034 DCON
USTUPDATE_iR2545_35_ There are three types DCON_vXXXX of DC controllers. USTUPDATE_iR2530_25_ DCON_vXXXX USTUPDATE_ iR2530_25_20_DCON_ vXXXX
T-6-5
Inner finisher
Target PCB
FIN_CON Finisher controller PCB
IFN_B1
Description on SST
Remarks
For the detailed procedure, refer to the service manual for the finisher.
T-6-6
CN22
F-6-5
6-8
6
Procedure
6-9
MEMO: The procedure for upgrading Boot is described below as a typical example. Use the same procedure for other firmware.
1) Turn ON the power switch of the PC and start up the UST. 2) When the power switch is turned ON, a Found New Hardware Wizard appears. Click [Cancel].
F-6-7
F-6-6
3) Enter the service mode. ( key > 2 Key > 8 Key > key) 4) Select [DOWNLOAD] by pressing the arrow key, then press the [OK] key. MEMO: You can also enter the download mode from the following user mode: > System Settings > Firmware Upgrade > Yes
F-6-8
6-9
6-10
F-6-9
F-6-11
MEMO: If firmware for a wrong model is selected, Specify by printer name is not displayed.
F-6-12
11) The following screen appears. UPDATING FIRMWARE is displayed on the control panel of this machine.
F-6-10 F-6-13
6-10
6
CAUTION:
6-11
Do Not Turn off the Power during Download/Write Operation in progress Do not turn OFF the power while the system software is being downloaded or written. The machine may fail to start when the power is turned ON.
12) When upgrade is complete, the following screen appears. Turn OFF then ON the main power switch to complete the procedure.
F-6-14
6-11
Error Code
Overview Error Code Jam Code Alarm Code
Error Code
7
Overview
Outline
7-2
This chapter describes various codes which are displayed when a failure occurs on the product. These are classified into 3 codes as follows. Code type
Error code Jam code Alarm code
Explanation
This code is displayed when an error occurs on the machine. This code is displayed when a jam occurs inside the machine. This code is displayed when a function of the machine is malfunctioned.
Reference
Refer to page 7-3 Refer to page 7-11 Refer to page 7-15
T-7-1
7-2
7
Error Code
Error Code Details
Ecode E000 Detail Code 0001 Item
Title Description Remedy
7-3
Ecode E002 Detail Code 0000 Item
Title Description
Description
Fixing unit temperature insufficient rise 1.The reading of the main thermistor is less than 115 deg C continuously for 400 msec 1.3 sec after it has indicated 100 deg C. 2.The reading of the main thermistor is less than 150 deg C continuously for 400 msec 1.3 sec after it has indicated 140 deg C. 1.Go through the following to clear the error: CLEAR > ENGIN > ERRCLR; and then turn OFF and then ON the power. 2.Check connection of the Connectors (Thermistor Connector and AC Connector). 3.Replace the Fixing Main Thermistor (Film Unit). 4.Replace the Fixing Assembly. 5.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Low fixing temperature detection after standby The reading of the main thermistor is less than 140 deg C continuously for 400 msec or more. 1.Go through the following to clear the error: CLEAR > ENGIN > ERRCLR; and then turn OFF and then ON the power. 2.Check connection of the Connectors (Thermistor Connector and AC Connector). 3.Replace the Fixing Main Thermistor (Film Unit). 4.Replace the Fixing Assembly. 5.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Thermistor disconnection detection error When disconnection is detected with connector (J214) for 30 sec continuously. 1.Check connection of the Connector (J214). 2.Replace the Film Unit. 3.Replace the Fixing Assembly. 4.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Unstable rotation of the Main Motor (M1) Detection is executed every 100 msec after the start of motor rotation; however, the drive detection signal is absent for 2 sec. 1.Replace the Main Motor (M1). 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Unstable rotation of the Main Motor (M1) During motor rotation, detection is executed every 100 msec; however, the drive signal is absent 5 times in sequence. 1.Replace the Main Motor (M1). 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4).
Description
Fixing temperature abnormal rise The temperature detected by the main thermistor does not rise to the specified value during startup control. 1.Go through the following to clear the error: CLEAR > ENGIN > ERRCLR; and then turn OFF and then ON the power. 2.Check connection of the Connectors (Thermistor Connector and AC Connector). 3.Replace the Fixing Main Thermistor (Film Unit). 4.Replace the Fixing Assembly. 5.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Fixing unit temperature rise detection The reading of the main thermistor is 250 deg C or more continuously for 200 msec. 1.Go through the following to clear the error: CLEAR > ENGIN > ERRCLR; and then turn OFF and then ON the power. 2.Check connection of the Connectors (Thermistor Connector and AC Connector). 3.Replace the Fixing Main Thermistor (Film Unit). 4.Replace the Fixing Assembly. 5.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Fixing unit temperature rise detection The hardware circuit detects overheating of the main or sub thermistor for 200 msec. 1.Go through the following to clear the error: CLEAR > ENGIN > ERRCLR; and then turn OFF and then ON the power. 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Fixing unit temperature rise detection The reading of the sub thermistor is 295 deg C or more continuously for 200 msec. 1.Go through the following to clear the error: CLEAR > ENGIN > ERRCLR; and then turn OFF and then ON the power. 2.Check connection of the Connectors (Thermistor Connector and AC Connector). 3.Replace the Fixing Main Thermistor (Film Unit). 4.Replace the Fixing Assembly. 5.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4).
Remedy
E003
0000
E001
0000
E004
0000
E001
0001
E010
0001
E001
0002
Title Description
Remedy
E010
0002
7-3
7
Ecode E014 Detail Code 0001 Item
Title Description
7-4
Ecode E024 Detail Code 0001 Item
Title Description
Description
Unstable rotation of the Fixing Motor (M2) Detection is executed every 100 msec after the start of motor rotation; however, the drive detection signal is absent for 2 sec. 1.Replace the Fixing Motor (M2). 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Unstable rotation of the Fixing Motor (M2) During motor rotation, detection is executed every 100 msec; however, the drive signal is absent 5 times in sequence. "1.Replace the Fixing Motor (M2). 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4)." Error in Waste Toner Sensor (S17) Warning when the sensor goes on for 2000 consecutive sheets, and error when the sensor goes on for 100 consecutive sheets. * Error occurs after the delivery if a paper in passage exists. 1.Replace the Waste Toner Sensor (S17). 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). The path between the sub hopper and the developing assembly is clogged with toner. The Developing Assembly Toner Sensor (TS1) detects the absence of toner,while the Sub Hopper Toner Sensor (TS2) detects the presence of toner. With the Developing Cylinder Clutch (CL3) turned on, the hopper feedscrew motor (M7) is rotated for 1 sec intermittently 194 times; still, theDeveloping Assembly Toner Sensor (TS1) does not detect the presence of toner. * Error occurs after the delivery if a paper in passage exists. 1.Check the rotation of hopper motor gear. (If rotating, false detection by the sensor is doubted. Feed the toner to the developing unit in service mode: CLEAR>ENGIN>TNRINST.) 2.Replace the Developing Assembly Toner Sensor (TS1). 3.Replace the Sub Hopper Toner Sensor (TS2). 4.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). The connector (J207) of Developing Assembly Toner Sensor (TS1) is disconnected. The Developing Assembly Toner Sensor (TS1) connection detection signal is absent for 100 msec 10 times in sequence. * Error occurs after the delivery if a paper in passage exists. 1.Check connection of the Connector (J207). 2.Replace the Developing Assembly Toner Sensor (TS1). 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4).
Description
The Developing Assembly Toner Sensor (TS1) is disconnected. <At LOW SPEED> - The developing assembly toner sensor (TS1) ON counter is checked every 2.5 seconds, and the counter increments 1 count every 25 times when the sensor goes on, and 300 counts are reached. <At HIGH SPEED> - The developing assembly toner sensor (TS1) ON counter is checked every 1.5 seconds, and the counter increments 1 count every 15 times when the sensor goes on, and 300 counts are reached. 1.Check connection of the Connector (J207). 2.Correct the cable. 3.Replace the Developing Assembly Toner Sensor (TS1). The connector (J207) of Sub Hopper Toner Sensor (TS2) is disconnected. The Sub Hopper Toner Sensor (TS2) connection detection signal is absent for 100 msec 10 times in sequence. * Error occurs after the delivery if a paper in passage exists. 1.Check connection of the Connector (J207). 2.Replace the Sub Hopper Toner Sensor (TS2). 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Failure of the Bottle Motor (M6) The bottle motor (M6) is unlocked when it goes on for 12 consecutive times at 0.1 sec. intervals. * Error occurs after the delivery if a paper in passage exists. 1.Replace the Bottle Motor (M6). 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Failure of the Scanner Motor (M21) The Scanner Motor (M21) speed lock signal does not indicate a locked state a specific period of time after the Scanner Motor (M21) has been started. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Check the cable. 2.Replace the Laser Scanner Unit. 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4).
Remedy
E014
0002
E019
0000
Title Description
Remedy
E025
0000
Title Description
Remedy
E020
0000
Title Description
Remedy
E025
0001
Title Description
Remedy
Remedy
E110
0001
Title Description
E024
0000
Title Description
Remedy
Remedy
7-4
7
Ecode E110 Detail Code 0002 Item
Title Description
7-5
Ecode E240 Detail Code 0000 Item
Title Description Remedy
Description
Failure of the Scanner Motor (M21) The speed lock signal indicates a deviation 10 times in sequence at intervals of 100 msec after the signal has indicated a locked state. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Check the cable. 2.Replace the Laser Scanner Unit. 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Failure of the Scanner Motor (M21) The scanner motor (M21) speed lock signal does not indicate a locked state for 6.5 sec. after a switchover is made from low to normal speed or for 8 sec. after a switchover is made from normal to low speed. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Check the cable. 2.Replace the Laser Scanner Unit. 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Error in EEPROM access 20 retries failed after error occurred during communication with EEPROM. * Error occurs after the delivery if a paper in passage exists. 1.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Error in communication of Laser Driver PCB (PCB14) Communication error 1 with image PCB 1.Check the cable. 2.Replace the Laser Scanner Unit. 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Error in communication of Laser Driver PCB (PCB14) Communication error 2 with image PCB 1.Check the cable. 2.Replace the Laser Scanner Unit. 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). There is an error in the detection of the CIS home position. 1.The attempt to detect the home position fails when the CIS is moved forward. 2.The attempt to detect the home position fails when the CIS is moved back. 1.Disconnect and then connect the flexible cable(Relay PCB (PCB2)-Main Controller PCB (PCB1) 64pin). 2.Replace the flexible cable. 3.Replace the CIS HP sensor (S31). 4.Replace the Scanner Motor (M31). 5.Replace the Relay PCB (PCB2). 6.Replace the Main Controller PCB (PCB1).
Description
Error in controller communication The serial communication error such as parity error or overrun error is constantly detected. 1.Check the Connectors. 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Error in controller communication The serial communication error such as parity error or overrun error is detected while printing. 1.Check the Connectors. 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Error in Zero Cross Zero Cross failed to be detected for 500ms or more while the relay was ON. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Check the Connectors. 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Communication error The communication with the host machine is interrupted. 1.Check the cable. 2.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB. EEPROM error The checksum for the EEPROM data has an error. 1.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Shift Motor (M4) error The shift roller does not leave the shift roller home position when the Shift Motor (M4) has been driven for 1.2 seconds. 1.Replace the Shift Roller HP Sensor (S2). 2.Replace the Shift Motor (M4). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Shift Motor (M4) error The shift roller does not return to the shift roller home position when the Shift Motor (M4) has been driven for 1.2 seconds. 1.Replace the Shift Roller HP Sensor (S2). 2.Replace the Shift Motor (M4). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Stapler Motor (M10) error The stapler does not leave the staple home position when the Staple Motor (M10) has been driven for 0.5 sec. 1.Check the wiring between the Finisher Controller PCB and Stapler. 2.Replace the Stapler. 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1).
Remedy
E240
0001
E110
0003
Title Description
E261
0000
Title Description
Remedy
Remedy
E500
0000
E196
0000
Title Description
E197
0000
E505 E520
0001 0001
E197
0001
E520
0002
E202
0000
Title Description
E531
8001
Remedy
7-5
7
Ecode E531 Detail Code 8002 Item
Title Description Remedy
7-6
Ecode E567 Detail Code 0001 Item
Title Description
Description
Stapler Motor (M10) error The stapler does not return to the staple home position when the Stapler Motor (M10) has been driven for 0.5 sec. 1.Check the wiring between the Finisher Controller PCB and Stapler. 2.Replace the Stapler. 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). STP Move Motor (M1) error The stapler does not leave the stapler move home position when the STP Move Motor (M1) has been driven for 0.25 sec. 1.Replace the Stapler Move HP Sensor (S10). 2.Check the wiring between the Finisher Controller PCB and the STP Move Motor. 3.Check the stapler shift base. 4.Replace the STP Move Motor (M1). 5.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). STP Move Motor (M1) error The stapler does not return to the stapler move home position when the STP Move Motor (M1) has been driven for 2.8 sec. 1.Replace the Stapler Move HP Sensor (S10). 2.Check the wiring between the Finisher Controller PCB and the STP Move Motor. 3.Check the stapler shift base. 4.Replace the STP Move Motor (M1). 5.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Tray Lift Motor (M11) time out error The stack tray does not move within a specified time period. 1.Replace the Tray Lift Motor (M11). 2.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Tray Lift Motor (M11) closing detect switch error The FG input cannot be detected when the Tray Lift Motor (M11) has been driven for 0.1 second. 1.Replace the Stack Tray Clock Sensor (S13). 2.Replace the Tray Lift Motor (M11). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Additional Tray Lift Motor (M12) time out error The stack tray does not move within a specified time period. 1.Replace the Additional Tray Lift Motor (M12). 2.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Additional Tray Lift Motor (M12) closing detect switch error The FG input cannot be detected when the Additional Tray Lift Motor (M12) has been driven for 0.1 second. 1.Replace the Additional Tray Clock Sensor (S23). 2.Replace the Additional Tray Lift Motor (M12). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1).
Description
Shift Roller Release Motor (M5) error The shift roller does not leave the shift roller release home position when the Shift Roller Release Motor (M5) has been driven for 0.1 sec. 1.Replace the Shift Roller Release Sensor (S3). 2.Replace the Shift Roller Release Motor (M5). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Shift Roller Release Motor (M5) error The shift roller does not return to the shift roller release home position when the Shift Roller Release Motor (M5) has been driven for 0.06 sec. 1.Replace the Shift Roller Release Sensor (S3). 2.Replace the Shift Roller Release Motor (M5). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Gripper Open/Close Motor (M7) error The gripper unit does not leave the gripper unit home position when the Gripper Open/Close Motor (M7) has been driven for 0.25 seconds. 1.Replace the Grip Arm Sensor (S13). 2.Replace the Gripper Open/Close Motor (M7). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Gripper Open/Close Motor (M7) error The gripper unit does not return to the gripper unit home position when the Gripper Open/Close Motor (M7) has been driven for 0.15 seconds. 1.Replace the Grip Arm Sensor (S13). 2.Replace the Gripper Open/Close Motor (M7). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Gripper Unit Move Motor (M2) error The gripper unit does not leave the gripper unit home position when the Gripper Unit Move Motor (M2) has been driven for 3.8 seconds. 1.Replace the Gripper Unit HP Sensor (S7). 2.Replace the Gripper Unit Move Motor (M2). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). Gripper Unit Move Motor (M2) error The gripper unit does not return to the gripper unit home position when the Gripper Unit Move Motor (M2) has been driven for 0.1 seconds. 1.Replace the Gripper Unit HP Sensor (S7). 2.Replace the Gripper Unit Move Motor (M2). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB (PCB1). The built-in SD card is not detected -
Remedy
E532
0001
E567
0002
Title Description
Remedy
E571
0001
E532
0002
Title Description
Remedy
E571
0002
Title Description
E540
0001
Remedy
E540
0005
E575
0001
Title Description
Remedy
E542
0001
E575
0002
Title Description
E542
0005
Remedy
E602
0001
7-6
7
Ecode E602 E711 Detail Code 1105 0001 Item
Title Description Remedy Title Description Remedy
7-7
Ecode E744 Detail Code 0001 Item
Title Description Remedy Title Description Remedy Title Description Remedy Title Description Remedy Title Description
Description
Access to the built-in SD card failed Error in UFDI communication The communication system error (such as reception timeout or checksum error) occurred. 1.Check and Replace the cable. 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB. Erroneous communication with finisher The communication does not restart by the error retry after the communication failure with the finisher. 1.Check the cable. 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 3.Replace the Finisher Controller PCB. Erroneous communication with optional cassette or 2-way unit After the presence of a cassette pedestal or a 2-way unit has been detected, the communication fails to be normal for 5 sec. 1.Check the cable. 2.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 3.Replace the Cassette Pedestal Driver PCB. 4.Replace the 2-way unit driver PCB. Failure of the communication with the 2-way unit When the communication with the 2-way unit is faulty after detecting the connection with the finisher. 1.Install the 2-way unit. 2.Check the cable. 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 4.Replace the 2-way unit driver PCB. Erroneous communication with New Card Reader (serial communication) Erroneous communication with Coin Vendor (serial communication) Erroneous communication between CCU and controller. -
Description
Mismatched version between the language file and the Bootable Oversized language file in HDD Mismatched version between the language file and the Bootable Language file reading error Failure of the Power Supply Cooloing Fan (FAN6) When lock signal is detected for 5 sec while the Power Supply Cooloing Fan (FAN6) is stopped. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Disconnect and then connect the connector (J205) on the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 2.Replace the Power Supply Cooloing Fan (FAN6). 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Unstable rotation of the Power Supply Cooloing Fan (FAN6) When lock signal failed to be detected for 5 sec while the Power Supply Cooloing Fan (FAN6) is driven. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Disconnect and then connect the connector (J205) on the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 2.Replace the Power Supply Cooloing Fan (FAN6). 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Failure of the Exhaust Fan (Rear) (FAN3) When lock signal is detected for 5 sec while the Exhaust Fan (Rear) (FAN3) is stopped. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Disconnect and then connect the connector (J206) on the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 2.Replace the Exhaust Fan (Rear) (FAN3). 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4).
E744 E744
0002 0003
E713
0000
E744 E804
0004 0000
E716
0000
Title Description
Remedy
Remedy
E716
0010
E804
0001
Title Description
Remedy
E719
0000
E805
0000
Title Description
E719
0002
Remedy
E736
0000
7-7
7
Ecode E805 Detail Code 0001 Item
Title Description
Error Code > Error Code > FAX Error Codes > User Error Code
7-8
Description
Unstable rotation of the Exhaust Fan (Rear) (FAN3) or Finisher Fan 1 (M8) or Finisher Fan 2 (M9) 1.When lock signal failed to be detected for 5 sec while the Exhaust Fan (Rear) (FAN3) is driven. 2.When lock signal failed to be detected for 5 sec while the Finisher Fan 1 (M8) is driven. 3.When lock signal failed to be detected for 5 sec while the Finisher Fan 2 (M9) is driven. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Disconnect and then connect the connector (J206) on the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 2.Replace the Exhaust Fan (Rear) (FAN3). 3.Replace the Finisher Fan 1 (M8). 4.Replace the Finisher Fan 2 (M9). 5.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Failure of the Exhaust Fan (Front) (FAN4) When lock signal is detected for 5 sec while the Exhaust Fan (Front) (FAN4) is stopped. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Disconnect and then connect the connector (J206) on the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 2.Replace the Exhaust Fan (Front) (FAN4). 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). Unstable rotation of the Exhaust Fan (Front) (FAN4) When lock signal failed to be detected for 5 sec while the Exhaust Fan (Front) (FAN4) is driven. * The same condition is detected after the error retry is performed. 1.Disconnect and then connect the connector (J206) on the DC Controller PCB (PCB4). 2.Replace the Exhaust Fan (Front) (FAN4). 3.Replace the DC Controller PCB (PCB4).
T-7-2
Remedy
E805
0002
Title Description
Remedy
E805
0003
Title Description
Remedy
Description
An original has jammed. Time-out for copying or sending/receiving a single page has occurred. Time-out for initial identification (T0/T1) has occurred. Recording paper has jammed or is absent. Recording paper is absent at the other party. Auto call initiation has failed. Image memory overflow at time of reception has occurred. The number you dial and connected number (CSI) does not match. A memory communication reservation has been cancelled.
T-7-3
Error Code > Error Code > FAX Error Codes > User Error Code
7-8
7
Service Error Code
Service Error Code
No. ##0100 ##0101 ##0102 ##0103 ##0104 ##0106 ##0107 ##0109 ##0111 ##0114 ##0200 ##0201 ##0224 ##0228 ##0232 ##0237 ##0261 ##0280 ##0281 ##0282 ##0283 ##0284 ##0285 ##0286 ##0287 ##0288 ##0289 ##0290 ##0670 Tx/Rx
[Tx] [Tx/Rx] [Tx] [Rx] [Tx] [Rx] [Rx] [Tx] [Tx/Rx] [Rx] [Rx] [Tx/Rx] [Tx] [Rx] [Tx] [Rx] [Tx/Rx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx] [Tx]
Error Code > Error Code > FAX Error Codes > Service Error Code
7-9
Description
At time of V.8 arrival, procedure fails to move to phase 2 after detection of CM signal from caller, causing T1 time-out and releasing line. At time of V.34 transmission, a shift in procedure from phase 2 to phase 3 and the reafter stops, causing the machine to release the line and suffer T1 timeout. At time of V.34 reception, a shift in procedure from phase 2 to phase 3 and thereafter stops, causing the machine to release the line and suffer T1 timeout. At time of V.34 transmission, a shift in procedure from phase 3 and phase 4 to the control channel and thereafter stops, causing the machine to release the line and suffer T1 timeout. At time of V.34 reception, a shift in procedure from phase 3 and phase 4 to the control channel and thereafter stops, causing the machine to release the line and suffer T1 timeout. At time of ECM transmission, no meaningful signal is received after transmission of PPS-NULL, causing the procedural signal to be transmitted more than specified. At time of ECM transmission, DCN is received after transmission of PPSNULL.. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of PPS-NULL, or T5 time-out (60 sec) has occurred. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of PPS-NULL. At time of ECM transmission, no meaningful signal is received after transmission of PPS-MPS, causing the procedural signal to be transmitted more than specified. At time of ECM transmission, DCN is received after retransmission of PPSMPS. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of PPS-MPS, or T5 time-out (60 sec) has occurred. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of PPS-MPS. At time of ECM transmission, DCN is received after transmission of PPSEOM. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of PPS-MPS, or T5 time-out (60 sec) has occurred. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of PPS-EOM. At time of ECM transmission, no meaningful signal is received after transmission of PPS-EOP, causing the procedural signal to be transmitted more than specified. At time of ECM transmission, DCN is received after transmission of PPS-EOP. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of PPS-EOP, or T5 time-out (60 sec) has occurred.
No. ##0671 Description ##0672 ##0673 ##0674 ##0675 ##0750 ##0752 ##0753 ##0754 ##0755 ##0757 ##0758 ##0759 ##0762 ##0763 ##0764 ##0765 ##0767 ##0768
Tx/Rx
[Rx] [Tx]
At time of transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified. The modem speed does not match that of the other party. At time of transmission, fall-back cannot be used. At time of reception, EOL cannot be detected for 5 sec (15 sec if CBT). At time of transmission, RTN or PIN is received. At time of reception, the procedural signal is received for 6 sec while in wait for the signal. At time of reception, the transmitting party cannot use fall-back. At time of transmission, a signal other than DIS, DTC, FTT, CFR, or CRP is received, and the procedural signal has been sent more than specified. Memory error has occurred. At time of reception, RTN is transmitted. At time of reception, no image carrier is detected for 5 sec. DCN is received outside the normal parity procedure. Communication protocol signal error. Abnormal management information of image data. Encoding error has occurred. Decoding error has occurred. System error has occurred. At time of transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified. At time of transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified. At time of transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified. At time of transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified. At time of transmission, DCN is received after transmission of TCF. At time of transmission, DCN is received after transmission of EOP. At time of transmission, DCN is received after transmission of EOM. At time of transmission, DCN is received after transmission of MPS. After transmission of EOP, a signal other than PIN, PIP, MCF, RTP, or RTN has been received. After transmission of EOM, a signal other than PIN, PIP, MCF, RTP, or RTN has been received. After transmission of MPS, a signal other than PIN, PIP, MCF, RTP, or RTN has been received. At time of V.8 lAte start, the V.8 ability of DIS front the receiving party is expected to be detected, and the CI signal is expected to be transmitted in response; however, the procedure fails to advance, and the line is released because of T1 time-out.
[Rx] [Tx]
[Rx]
[Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
Error Code > Error Code > FAX Error Codes > Service Error Code
7-9
7
No. ##0769 ##0770 ##0772 ##0773 ##0774 ##0775 ##0778 ##0779 ##0780 ##0782 ##0783 ##0784 ##0787 ##0788 ##0789 ##0790 ##0791 ##0792 ##0793 ##0794 ##0795 Tx/Rx
[Tx]
Error Code > Error Code > FAX Error Codes > Service Error Code
7-10
Description
At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of PPS-EOP, or T5 time-out (60 sec) has occurred. At time of ECM transmission, no meaningful signal is received after transmission of EOR-NULL, causing the procedural signal to be transmitted more than specified. At time of ECM transmission, DCN is received after transmission of EORNULL.. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of EOR-NULL, or T5 time-out (60 sec) has occurred. At time of ECM transmission, ERR is received after transmission of EORNULL.. At time of ECM transmission, no meaningful signal is received after transmission of EOR-MPS, causing the procedural signal to be transmitted more than specified. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission EOR-MPS, or T5 time-out (60 sec) has occurred. At time of ECM transmission, ERR is received after transmission of EORMPS. At time of ECM transmission, no meaningful signal is received after transmission of EOR-EOM, causing the procedural signal to be transmitted more than specified. At time of ECM transmission, DCN is received after transmission of EOREOM. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of EOR-EOM, or T5 time-out (60 sec) has occurred. At time of ECM transmission, no meaningful signal is received after transmission of EOR-EOP, causing the procedural signal to be transmitted more than specified. At time of ECM transmission, DCN is received after transmission of EOR-EOP. At time of ECM transmission, the procedural signal has been transmitted more than specified after transmission of EOR-EOP, or T5 time-out (60 sec) has occurred. At time of ECM transmission, ERR is received after transmission of EOR-EOP. At time of ECM reception, ERR is transmitted after transmission of EOR-Q. While ECM mode procedure is under way, a signal other than a meaningful signal is received. At time of ECM reception, PPS-NULL cannot be detected over partial page processing. At time of ECM reception, no effective frame is received while high-speed signal reception is under way, thus causing time-out. At time of ECM reception, PPR with all 0s is received. A fault has occurred in code processing for communication.
T-7-4
[Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
[Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
[Tx]
[Tx] [Tx]
Error Code > Error Code > FAX Error Codes > Service Error Code
7-10
7
Jam Code
Main Unit
550-sheet 1st cassette model
7-11
S40
S40
S42
S42
S12
S12
S19
S19
S7 S5 S5
S7
S1
F-7-2 F-7-1
7-11
7
ACC ID 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 Jam Code 0101 0102 0103 0104 0105 0107 0108 0109 010A 010D 0201 0202 0203 0204 0205 0207 0208 0209 020A 020D 0A01 0A02 0A03 0A04 0A05 0A07 0A08 0A09 0A0A 0A0D 0B00 0CF1 0D91 FF00 FF01 FF02 FF03 FF04 FF05 FF07 FF08 FF09 FF0A Type Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Delay jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Power-on jam Door open jam Other jams Wrong size specified Unknown jam Unknown jam Unknown jam Unknown jam Unknown jam Unknown jam Unknown jam Unknown jam Unknown jam Unknown jam
7-12
ACC ID 3 3 3 Jam Code Type FF0D Unknown jam FF91 Unknown jam FFF1 Unknown jam Sensor Name
T-7-5
Sensor Name
Cassette 1 pickup sensor Cassette 2 pickup sensor Cassette 3 pickup sensor Cassette 4 pickup sensor Pre-registration sensor Fixing outlet sensor No. 1 delivery sensor No. 2 delivery sensor Reversal sensor Duplex feed sensor Cassette 1 pickup sensor Cassette 2 pickup sensor Cassette 3 pickup sensor Cassette 4 pickup sensor Pre-registration sensor Fixing outlet sensor No. 1 delivery sensor No. 2 delivery sensor Reversal sensor Duplex feed sensor Cassette 1 pickup sensor Cassette 2 pickup sensor Cassette 3 pickup sensor Cassette 4 pickup sensor Pre-registration sensor Fixing outlet sensor No. 1 delivery sensor No. 2 delivery sensor Reversal sensor Duplex feed sensor Pre-registration sensor -
Sensor ID
S1 SR2 SR4 SR8 S5 S19 S12 S42 S40 S7 S1 SR2 SR4 SR8 S5 S19 S12 S42 S40 S7 S1 SR2 SR4 SR8 S5 S19 S12 S42 S40 S7 S5 -
Sensor ID
7-12
7
DADF-AB1
PI11
7-13
ACC ID 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 Jam Code 0003 0004 0005 0006 0007 0008 0044 0045 0046 0047 0048 0071 0090 0091 0092 0093 0094 0095 Type Delay jam Stationary jam Delay jam Stationary jam Delay jam Stationary jam Stationary jam (first document) Delay jam (first document) Stationary jam (first document) Delay jam (first document) Stationary jam (first document) Timing error ADF open jam Sensor Name
Registration sensor Registration sensor Read sensor Read sensor Delivery reversal sensor Delivery reversal sensor Registration sensor Read sensor Read sensor Delivery reversal sensor Delivery reversal sensor
Sensor ID
PI8 PI8 PI7 PI7 PI6 PI6 PI8 PI7 PI7 PI6 PI6 S21 S21 PI10 PI10 PI6, PI7, PI8 PI11
T-7-6
PI8
PI6 PI7
PI10 PI11
4 4 4 4 4 4 4
Copyboard cover open/closed Sensor 0 User ADF open jam Copyboard cover open/closed Sensor 0 ADF cover open jam Cover open/closed sensor User cover open jam Cover open/closed sensor Initial stationary jam Registration sensor or Read sensor or Delivery reversal sensor Document set sensor Pickup NG
7-13
7
Inner Finisher-B1
S22
7-14
ACC ID 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 Jam Code 1001 1101 1102 1300 1400 1500 1C20 1C32 1C40 1C42 1C67 1C6F 1C71 1C75 1F00 Type Delay jam Stationary jam Stationary jam Power-on jam Door open jam STP jam Error jam Error jam Error jam Error jam Error jam Error jam Error jam Error jam Other jams Sensor Name
Entrance sensor Entrance sensor Processing tray sensor Entrance sensor, Processing tray sensor Front cover switch Stapler HP sensor, Stapler edging sensor Shift roller HP sensor Stapler move HP sensor Stack tray clock sensor Additional tray clock sensor Shift roller release sensor Entrance roller release /stopper HP sensor Grip arm sensor Gripper unit HP sensor Entrance sensor
Sensor ID
S1 S1 S6 S1, S6 SW1 S18, S19 S2 S10 S14 S23 S3 S5 S13 S7 S1
T-7-7
S2
S1
S15
S16
S6
5 5 5
S10 S7
F-7-4
7-14
7
Alarm Code
Alarm Code Details
Alarm Code Title 37 - 0001 Repair Request (Corrupt
Image) Jam)
7-15
37 37 37 37 37 37 37 37
0002 Repair Request (Paper 0003 Repair Request (Corrupt 0004 0005 0006 0007 1000 2000
Image/Paper Jam) Repair Request (Other Problems) Repair Request (Corrupt Image/Other Problems) Repair Request (Paper Jam/Other Problems) Repair Request (Corrupt Image/Paper Jam/Other Problems) Repair Request Cancel Repair Completed -
T-7-8
7-15
Service Mode
Outline Details of Service Mode
Service Mode
8
Outline
Outline of Service Mode
8-2
#CODEC This is a setting items related to CODEC. #SYSTEM This is a setting items related to SYSTEM. #ACC Register the accessories. #COUNTER Use it to check estimates for maintenance/parts replacement. #LMS Use it to set the inactivity of the transmitted license and the license inactivity without transmitting. #E-RDS This is a setting items related to e-RDS (Embedded RDS). #REPORT Use it to generate reports on various service data. #DOWNLOAD Use it to download firmware to the ROM of a PCB in question. #CLEAR Use it to reset various data to initial settings. #DISPLAY The error and detailed code which have happened now are displayed. Display the engine speed of the main controller PCB. #ROM Displays ROM information, such as version numbers and checksums. #TEST MODE Makes various status checks, such as contact sensor, sensor and print status.
The items that follow may be checked/set using the machine's service mode, which is designed the way the service mode used in fax machines is designed in terms of contents and operation. #SSSW Use it to register/set basic fax functions (e.g., error control, echo remedy, communication error correction). Use it to make settings related counter functions. #MENU Use it to register/set items related to functions needed at time of installation (e.g., NL equalizer, transmission level). #NUMERIC These setting items are for inputting numeric parameters such as the various conditions for the RTN signal transmission. #SPECIAL These setting items are for telephone network control functions. Do not use. #NCU These setting items are for telephone network control functions such as the selection signal transmission conditions and the detection conditions, for the control signals sent from the exchange. #FAX Do not use. #SCAN These setting items are for image adjustment in scanning. #PRINT These setting items are for image adjustment in printer assembly and for special mode for the field-related measures. #NETWORK Use it to confirm the contents of the installed CA certificates.
8-2
8
Using the Mode
<Operation at the time of Bit SW> 1) Selecting Service Mode
Service Mode > Outline > Setting of Bit Switch > Outline
8-3
Outline
Bit Switch Composition The items registered and set by each of these switches comprise 8-bit switches. The figure below shows which numbers are assigned to which bits. Each bit has a value of either 0 or 1.
000000000
2) Selecting a Menu Item Select the Menu item using the [left arrow]/[right arrow] on the touch panel. #NUMERIC 3) Press [OK]. #NUMERIC 001
#SSSW 001
CAUTION:
0
Do not change service data identified as "not used"; they are set as initial settings.
4) Selecting a Bit Switch Select the bit using the [left arrow]/[right arrow] on the touch panel. 000000000 5) Registering/Setting Data Enter data using the keypad, and press the [OK]. #SSSW 033 000000001 6) Press the [Stop]/[Additional functions]/[Reset] key to end the service mode. #SSSW 033
4) Selecting a Prarameter Select the Prarameter using the [left arrow]/[right arrow]. #NUMERIC 002 0 5) Registering/Setting Data Enter data using the keypad, and then press [OK]. #NUMERIC 002 10 6) Press the [Stop]/[Additional functions]/[Reset] key to end the service mode.
F-8-1
Bi t7 Bi t6 Bi t5 Bi t4 Bi t3 Bi t2 Bi t1 Bi t0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
F-8-2
#SSSW
#SSSW
Service Mode > Outline > Setting of Bit Switch > Outline
8-3
8
Back-Up
8-4
Service Label
The item of service kabel is described below. In this machine, the output of the service label does not support.
At time of shipment from the factory, all machines are adjusted individually, and adjustment values are recorded in their respective service labels. If you have replaced the CCD/CIS unit or the DC controller PCB, or if you have initialized the RAM, the adjustment values will return to their default settings. If there has been any change in a service mode item, be sure to update its setting indicated on the service label. As necessary, make use of the space in the service label (as when recording an item not found on the label). - Service Label: behind the rear cover (right))
FACTORY 1 2 3 #PRINT> #PRINT NUMERIC> 034 xxx 035 xxx 036 xxx 037 xxx 038 xxx 054 xxx 136 xxx 140 xxx 141 xxx 142 xxx 143 xxx 145 xxx 146 xxx 147 xxx 148 xxx 149 xxx 150 xxx SCAN> READER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> ADJ-X xxx ADJ-Y xxx ADJ-S xxx ADJ-Y-DF xxx STRD-POS xxx
FACTORY 1 2 3 SCAN> READER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> ADJ-X-MG xxx SCAN> READER> ADJUST> CCD> W-PLT-X xxx W-PLT-Y xxx W-PLT-Z xxx 50_RG xxx 50_GB xxx 100_RG xxx 100_GB xxx MTF3-M1 xxx MTF3-M2 xxx MTF3-M3 xxx MTF3-M4 xxx MTF3-M5 xxx MTF3-M6 xxx MTF3-M7 xxx MTF3-M8 xxx MTF3-M9 xxx SCAN> READER> ADJUST> PASCAL> OFST-P-K xxx SCAN> FEEDER> ADJUST> DOCST xxx LA-SPEED xxx DOC-LNGH xxx
Body No
F-8-4
F-8-3
8-4
8
Details of Service Mode
#SSSW
SSSW Composition
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-5
Details
SSSW-SW01
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Function
service error code not used not used not used not used not used not used not used
1
output -
0
not output T-8-2
NOTE: This document describes the default settings for the system for USA. The default settings used in the service mode vary depending on the shipping destination and model.
No. SW01 SW02 SW03 SW04 SW05 SW06 SW7-SW11 SW12 SW13 SW14 SW15 SW16 SW17 SW18 SW19-21 SW22 SW23-24 SW25 SW26-27 SW28 SW29 SW30 SW31 SW32 SW33 SW34 SW35 SW36 - SW50
Initial setting 00000000 00010000 00000000 00000000 00000000 10010000 00000010 00000000 00000001 00000000 00000011 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000011 00001000
Function error/copy control network connection setting echo remedy setting communication fault remedy setting standard function (DIS signal) setting read condition setting not used page timer setting meter/inch resolution setting inch/meter resolution setting dial-in FAX/TEL switch-over function settings for a No Paper display not used remedies for communication faults (2) not used fault remedy setting not used report indication resolution setting not used V.8/V.34 protocol settings not used Assigning a New Dial Tone Detection Method not used not used counter function settings waste toner full display setting e-RDS function settings not used
T-8-1
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 Selects whether or not service error codes are output. When output is selected, service error codes is report.
SSSW-SW02
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Function
not used not used not used not used not used not used not used F network silent termination service
1
Compatible
0
Not compatible
T-8-3
Detailed Discussions of Bit 7 Select whether or not the machine is compatible with the F network (facsimile communication network) silent termination service. When "Compatible" is selected, the machine automatically receives a fax upon detection of the FC signal (1300 Hz tonal signal) without generating a ringtone.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-5
8
SSSW-SW03
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-6
Function
TCF criteria Echo protect tone for high-speed transmission not used not used not used not used not used Tonal signal before CED signal transmission
1
Loose Transmitted Transmitted
0
Normal Not transmitted Not transmitted
T-8-4
MEMO: Any of the following error code may be indicated because of an echo at time of reception ##0005, ##0101, ##0106, ##0107, ##0114, ##0200, ##0201, ##0790
SSSW-SW04
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Function
not used Check CI frequency the number of final flag sequences of protocol signals Reception mode after CFR signal transmission the length of the period of ignoring low speed signals after CFR output Frequency of CI signal is checked when PBX is set. CNG signal for manual transmission CED signal for manual reception
1
Yes 2 high speed 1500ms
0
No 1 high speed/low speed 700ms
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 Select whether to make the TCF criteria loose when the system with a V.34 modem receives an image using the V.17 protocol. When "Loose" is selected, fallback hardly occurs when an image is received using the V.17 protocol. However, since the transmission speed is fast, erroneous lines can be generated after start of image reception or the communication time can become long due to retransmission of erroneous frames. Detailed Discussions of Bit 1 Selects whether or not the echo protect tone is transmitted for high-speed transmission (9600 or 7200 bps). If errors due to line conditions occur frequently during fax transmission, select Transmitted. When Transmitted is selected, a non-modulated carrier is transmitted as a synchronization signal before the image transmission. MEMO: Codes for errors that can occur during transmission because of line conditions: ##100, ##104, ##281, ##282, ##283, ##750, ##755, ##760,##765
Detailed Discussions of Bit 1 In automatic recieving, CI frequency check can be selected. If Yes is selected, the upper and lower limits of the CI frequency are checked, and automatic recieving can only go ahead if both values meet German regulations. Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 Use it to select the number of last flag sequences for a protocol signal (transmission speed at 300 bps). Select '2' if the other party fails to receive the protocol signal properly. MEMO: Any of the following error codes may be indicated at time of transmission ##0100, ##0280, ##0281, ##0750, ##0753, ##0754, ##0755, ##0758, ##0759, ##0760, ##0763 ##0764, ##0765, ##0768, ##0769,##0770, ##0773, ##0775, ##0778, ##0780, ##0783, ##0785, ##0788
Detailed Discussions of Bit 7 Use it to enable/disable transmission of a 1080-Hz tonal signal before transmission of the CED signal. Select 'transmit' if errors occur frequently because of an echo when reception is from overseas. Detailed Discussions of Bit 3 Use it to select an appropriate reception mode after transmission of the CFR signal. If errors occur frequently at time of reception because of the condition of the line, select 'high speed' for reception mode and, at the same time, selects 'do not receive' for 'ECM reception.'
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-6
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-7
1
-
MEMO: Any of the following error codes may be indicated at time of reception because of line condition ##0107, ##0114, ##0201 Be sure to change bit 4 before changing this bit; if errors still occur, change this bit. When 'high speed' is selected, only high-speed signals (images) will be received after transmission of the CFR signal.
Bit
7
Function
not used
0
T-8-6
Detailed Discussions of Bit 1 Use it to enable/disable millimeter/inch conversion in sub scanning direction for images read in text mode. Scanning direction in conversion follows the Bit 2 setting of SW14. Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 Use it to enable/disable millimeter/inch conversion in sub scanning direction for images read in text/photo mode while bit 1 is set to '1'. Scanning direction in conversion follows the Bit 2 setting of SW14. Detailed Discussions of Bit 3 Use it specify whether or not to transmit bit 33 and thereafter for the DIS signal. If prohibit is selected, Super Fine reception from a non-Canon machine can no longer be used. CAUTION: If prohibit is selected, Super Fine reception from a non-Canon machine can no longer be used.
Detailed Discussions of Bit 4 Use it to select the time length during which low-speed signals are ignored after transmission of the CFR signal. If the condition of the line is not good and, therefore, the reception of image signals is difficult, select '1500 ms.' Detailed Discussions of Bit 5 In the countries that need approval of CI signal frequency check, no checking on frequency set at PBX when changing the frequency to PSTN setting and PBX setting for frequency checks. Detailed Discussions of Bit 6 Selects whether or not to transmit CNG signal during manual transmission. In manual transmitting to a fax with the FAX/TEL switching mode, if there are frequent errors due to failure to switch to fax mode, select "Transmitted" for the CNG signal. Detailed Discussions of Bit 7 Selects whether or not to transmit CED signals during manual reception. If the other fax does not transmit even when you start manual reception, select "Transmitted" for the CED signal.
Detailed Discussions of Bit 4 Selects whether or not the recording paper length declared in the DIS signal is A4 size. When receiving documents made up of long pages, to have the document divided into two pages at the transmitting fax, select A4 size. MEMO: When A4 size is selected, this fax uses the DIS signal to tell the transmitting fax that it is equipped with A4 size recording paper. The transmitting fax that receives this DIS signal divides long pages into A4 size pages before transmitting it to the receiving fax. Some fax models do not so divide long documents.
SSSW-SW05
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Function
not used Conversion from mm to inch (text mode) Conversion from mm to inch (text/photo mode) transmit bit 33 and thereafter for DIS signal Recording paper length availability declared in DIS signal not used not used
1
execute execute prohibit A4 /B4 size -
0
do not execute do not execute do not prohibit Arbitrary size -
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-7
8
SSSW-SW06
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-8
Bit7 Bit6 * * * * Bit5 * * * * Bit4 * * * * Bit3 * * * * Bit2 * * * * Bit1 0 0 1 1 Bit0 0 1 0 1
T-8-9
Function
not used not used not used FAX stamp display setting original read width not used not used not used
1
Displayed LTR -
0
Not displayed A4 T-8-7
0 0 0 0
Detailed Discussions of Bit 3 stamp unit. Detailed Discussions of Bit 4 Use it to select a read width for originals. If LTR is selected, the machine will read LTR originals at LTR width (214mm).
Select whether to display the stamp menu in the user menu after installation of the optional
Time-Out Length for Transmission (image mode other than text mode)
Bit7 Bit6 * * * * Bit5 * * * * Bit4 * * * * Bit3 0 0 1 1 Bit2 0 1 0 1 Bit1 * * * * Bit0 * * * *
T-8-11
SSSW-SW012
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 1 1 1
Function
1-page time-out length for transmission not used 1-page time-out length for transmission (HT transmission) not used 1-page time-out length for reception not used not used page timer setting by transmission/reception
1
1 1 1 set
0
0 0 0 do not set
T-8-8
The machine will stop the ongoing communication if the transmission/reception of a single original page takes 32 min or more. To use the timer for a purpose other than this function, refer to the tables that follow, and select an appropriate time length. When 'do not enable' is selected using bit 7, the time-out length for a single page for all modes will depend on the setting of bit 0 and bit 1.
SSSW-SW013
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2
Function
0
do not convert
not used not used Convert "inch" into "mm" when transmitting the convert received image data
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-8
8
Bit
3 4 5 6 7
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-9
1
telephone line Yes Yes -
Function
not used not used not used not used not used
1
-
0
T-8-13
Bit
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Function
timing for storing polarity in memory Reception of call through caller ID display line (main unit line) not used not used not used Detection of continuous signal at fax/tel switchover not used
0
after CI detection No No T-8-15
Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 It converts "inch" into "mm" when transmitting the received image data. Scanning direction in conversion follows the Bit 2 setting of SW14.
SSSW-SW014
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
When a dial-in fax/tel switch-cover takes place, the polarity of the telephone line is stored in memory for detection of reversal of the polarity of the telephone line. The timing may be set 1 0 so that it is either after detection of CI or after release of the telephone line. Some switchboards are known to wrongly store the polarity, which can further cause the machine to enter standby state when the telephone line is released, thus disabling communication with the other party. If such is the case, be sure to select after release of telephone line. CAUTION: If the switch is set to after release of telephone line, the reversal of the polarity cannot be detected from when CI is detected to when the telephoneline is released.
T-8-14
Function
not used not used direction of scanning for inch/mm conversion not used inch-configuration resolution declaration not used not used not used
both main and sub sub scanning scanning directions direction only declare do not declare -
Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 Use it to specify whether to convert or not convert an inch-configuration resolution into a millimeter-configuration resolution for image read in G3 transmission: either in sub scanning direction only or in both main and sub scanning directions. The setting is valid only when bit 1 of SW05 of #SSSW is set to '1'. Detailed Discussions of Bit 4 Use it to specify whether to declare or not declare an inch-configuration resolution to the other machine for G3 communication: if 'declare' is selected, the machine will indicate that it reads and records at an inch-configuration resolution using the DIS, DCS, or DTC signal.
Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 When a machine which is not compatible with the caller ID display/modem dial-in service is connected to the subscriber line which is compatible with that service, the "main unit line" is made ready for receiving the incoming call. Detailed Discussions of Bit 6 Select whether to detect a continuous ROT signal at FAX/TEL switchover.
SSSW-SW16
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2
SSSW-SW15
List of Functions Bit
0
Function
No Paper display conditions
1
Same size fax paper
0
Either one All fax paper Check -
Function
not used
1
-
0
-
Check side cassette paper at No Paper display Do not check not used -
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-9
8
Bit
3 4 5 6 7
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-10
Function
not used not used not used not used not used
1
-
0
T-8-16
SSSW-SW22
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Function
not used not used not used Prohibit manual polling not used not used not used not used
1
Yes -
0
No T-8-18
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 Selects a No Paper display for when; either the fax paper cassette or multitray is empty, or for when the same size paper is all used up. Detailed Discussions of Bit 1 Selects whether to check the side cassette when checking if the same size paper is all used up.
Detailed Discussions of Bit 3 Selects whether to prohibit by manual polling (off hook key + start key).
SSSW-SW18
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
SSSW-SW25
List of Functions 1
detect 600msec -
Function
detection of carrier between DCS and TCF wait time for carrier between DCS and TCF not used not used not used not used not used not used
0
do not detect 300msec T-8-17
Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Function
Transmission telephone numbers displayed on reports from CSI not used If void CSI has been received, handle as non-received CSI. Menu display of message language not used not used not used not used
1
Other fax number Yes Display -
0
Called number No Do not display T-8-19
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 For reception, the absence of the carrier between DCS and TCF may be detected. If the machine returns FTT while the other party (PC-FAX in particular) is sending TCF to cause a reception error, be sure to set the bit to 1. If the error still occurs, set bit 1 of #1 SSSW SW18 to 1. This function is valid only when the machine uses an R288F modem. Detailed Discussions of Bit 1 For reception, the length of time during which the absence of the carrier is detected between DCS and TCF may be set. This bit is valid when 1 is set to bit 0 of #1 SSSW SW18.
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 Selects the transmission telephone number displayed on reports after the completion of transmission. When Called number is selected, the telephone number the fax called is displayed on reports. When Other fax number is selected, the telephone number sent from the other fax (the CSI signal data) is displayed on reports. Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 At "1" on this Bit, ignore the void CSI if received and if the dial has been made at this point,
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-10
8
the dialed number will be indicated on the LCD/ Report screen.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-11
At "0" on this Bit, even though the dialed number is acknowledged, LCD/Report screen will indicate nothing. Detailed Discussions of Bit 3 When Display is selected, adds a Message Language menu to the user data System Setting. This allows selecting different languages which to show displays and reports.
Detailed Discussions of Bit 4 Select whether the receiver falls back during V.34 reception. If 'Prohibit' is selected, the receiver does not fall back. Detailed Discussions of Bit 5 Select whether the transmitter falls beck during V.34 transmission. If 'Prohibit' is selected, teh transmitter does not fall back.
SSSW-SW28
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
SSSW-SW30
1
No No No No Prohibited Prohibited -
Function
Caller V.8 protocol Called party V.8 protocol Caller V.8 protocol late start Called party V.8 protocol late start V.34 reception fallback V.34 transmission fallback not used not used
0
Yes Yes Yes Yes Not prohibited Not prohibited T-8-20
Function
not used not used not used not used not used New dial tone detection method not used not used
1
Detect with the new method. -
0
Detect with the existing method. T-8-21
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 Select whether to use the V.8 protocol when calling. If NO is selected, the V.8 protocol is inhibited at calling and the V.21 protocol is used Detailed Discussions of Bit 1 Select whether to use the V.8 protocol when called. If NO is selected, the V8 protocol is inhibited when called and the V.21 protocol is used. Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 If ANSam signal is not received during transmission, select whether to use the V.8 protocol when the other fax machine declares the V.8 protocol in DIS signal. If NO is selected, the CI signal is not transmitted and the V.8 protocol is not used even if the DIS that specifies the V.8 protocol is received. The V.8 late start is not executed during manual transmission regardless of this setting. Detailed Discussions of Bit 3 Select whether to declare the V.8 protocol in DIS signal for reception. If NO is selected, the V.8 protocol cannot be used because it is not declared in DIS signal. The V.8 late start is not executed during manual reception regardless of this setting.
Detailed Discussions of Bit 5 When "Detect with the new method" is selected, tone is detected for 3.5 seconds before call origination in order to discriminate between dial tone and voice. If dial tone is detected and the time since line seizure is 3.5 seconds or longer, call origination takes place immediately. If the time since line seizure is less than 3.5 seconds, call origination takes place after waiting for 1 second. (If the time since line seizure reaches 3.5 seconds during the 1-second waiting period, call origination takes place immediately. By default, "Detect with a new method" is assigned for this SW.
SSSW-SW32
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4
Function
not used not used not used not used not used
1
-
0
-
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-11
8
Bit
5 6 7
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-12
Function
not used not used not used
1
-
0
T-8-22
When "1" is selected, the counter is displayed. When "0" is selected, the counter is not displayed.
SSSW-SW34
List of Functions Bit
0
SSSW-SW33
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Function
Display the waste toner full warning Switch the waste toner full warning User drum replacement menu display not used not used not used not used not used
Function
count B4 (Print) as large size not used count B4 (Scan) as large size the counter display type change in Japan and USA not used Toner cartridge replacement counter display not used not used
1
Yes Yes Yes Yes -
0
No No No No T-8-23
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Yes No Drum replacement required E019 displayed on message displayed on an an service call operator call Yes No T-8-25
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 Use it to specify whether B4 paper (Print) should be counted as large-size paper. If 'yes' is selected, B4 paper will be counted as large-size paper. If 'no' is selected, on the other hand, B4 paper will be counted as small-size paper. Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 Use it to specify whether B4 paper (Scan) should be counted as large-size paper. If 'yes' is selected, B4 paper will be counted as large-size paper. If 'no' is selected, on the other hand, B4 paper will be counted as small-size paper. Detailed Discussions of Bit 3/4 Select whether to switch the counter display type in effect in Japan and USA to the conventional or new type. Select "Yes" to display counters in the new type. Select "No" to display counters in the conventional type. Bit4
Conventional type(type1) New type(type2) New type(type3) New type(type4) 0 0 1 1
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 You can select whether a waste toner full warning is to be displayed. When "1" is selected, a waste toner full warning is displayed. When "0" is selected, a waste toner full warning is not displayed. Detailed Discussions of Bit 1 Select whether to display the waste toner full warning as a drum replacement required message or as E019 displayed on an operator call. Select 1 to display a rum replacement required message on an operator call. Select 0 to display E019 on an service call. Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 Select whether to display the user drum replacement menu. When "1" is selected, the menu is displayed. When "0" is selected, the menu is not displayed.
Bit3
0 1 0 1
T-8-24
Detailed Discussions of Bit 5 Select whether to display the toner cartridge replacement counter.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SSSW > Details
8-12
8
SSSW-SW35
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #MENU > Deatails
8-13
#MENU
1
Yes Yes enable enable Yes -
Function
e-RDS function ON/OFF Call button function ON/OFF ScanToMeia function enable/disable MediaPrint function enable/disable IC card authentication management function ON/OFF not used not used not used
0
No No disable disable No T-8-26
Function
NL equalizer Telephone line monitor Transmission level (ATT) V.34 modulation speed upper limit V34 data speed upper limit
Range of settings
1: ON, 0: OFF 0: DIAL, 1: SERVICEMAN [1], 2: SERVICEMAN [2], 3: OFF From 0 to 15 (ex: 15= -15 dBm) 0: 3429, 1: 3200, 2: 3000, 3: 2800, 4: 2743, 5: 2400 0: 33.6kbs, 1: 31.2kbs, 2: 28.8kbs, 3: 26.4kbs, 4: 24.0kbs 5: 21.6kbs, 6: 19.2kbs, 7: 16.8kbs, 8: 14.4kbs, 9: 12.0kbs 10: 9.6kbs, 11: 7.2kbs, 12: 4.8kbs, 13: 2.4kbs
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 Select whether to set the e-RDS function. When "1" is selected, the function is set. When "0" is selected, the function is not set. Detailed Discussions of Bit 1 Select whether to set the call button function. When "1" is selected, the function is set. When "0" is selected, the function is not set. Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 Select whether to enable or disable the ScanToMeia function. When "1" is selected, the function is enabled. When "0" is selected, the function is disabled. Detailed Discussions of Bit 3 Select whether to enable the MediaPrint function. When "1" is selected, the function is enabled. When "0" is selected, the function is disabled. Detailed Discussions of Bit 4 Select whether to set the IC card authentication function. When "1" is selected, the function is set. When "0" is selected, the function is not set.
010
Deatails
<005: NL equalizer>
Use it to enable-disable the NL equalizer. If errors occur often during communication because of the condition of the line, enable (ON) the NL equalizer.
MEMO: Any of the following error codes may be indicated at time of transmission because of the line condition: ##100, ##101, ##102, ##104, ##201, ##281, ##282, ##283, ##750, ##755, ##765, ##774, ##779, ##784, ##789 Any of the following error codes may be indicated at time of transmission because of the line condition: ##103, ##107, ##114, ##201, ##790, ##793
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #MENU > Deatails
8-13
8
<007: ATT transmission level>
Use it to set the transmission level (ATT).
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Numerical Parameter Composition
8-14
#NUMERIC
Numerical Parameter Composition
No.
002 003 004 005 006 010 011 013 015 016 017 018 019 020 021 022 023 024 025 027 051 053 054 055 056 057 058 059 060 061 074 075
Raise the transmission level if errors occur frequently at time of communication because of the condition of the line. (It means close to 8) MEMO: Any of the following error codes may be indicated at time of transmission because of the line condition: ##100, ##101, ##102, ##104, ##201, ##280, ##281, ##282, ##283, ##284, ##750, ##752, ##754, ##755, ##757, ##759, ##760, ##762, ##764, ##765, ##767, ##769, ##770, ##772, ##774, ##775, ##777, ##779, ##780, ##782, ##784, ##785, ##787, ##789 Any of the following error codes may be indicated at time of reception because of the line condition: ##103, ##106, ##107, ##201, ##793 ##103, ##106, ##107, ##201, ##793
Item
RTN transmission condition(1) RTN transmission condition (2) RTN transmission condition (3) NCC pause time length (pre-ID code) NCC pause time length (post-ID code) line condition identification time length T.30T1 timer (for reception) T.30 EOL timer hooking detection time length time length to first response at time of fax/tel switchover pseudo RBT signal pattern ON time length pseudo RBT signal pattern OFF time length (short) pseudo RBT signal pattern OFF time length (long) pseudo CI signal pattern ON time length pseudo CI signal pattern OFF time length (short) pseudo CI signal pattern OFF time length (long) CNG detection level at time of fax/tel switchover pseudo RBT transmission level at time of fax/tel switchover Answering machine connection function signal detection time preamble detection time length for V21 low-speed flag Hooking detection threshold Setting of DTMF call origination count at remote reception of fax Setting of busy tone output time when handset is used acquisition period of environmental log data display the type of soft counter 1 Display the type of soft counter 2 Display the type of soft counter 3 Display the type of soft counter 4 Display the type of soft counter 5 Display the type of soft counter 6 e-RDS RGW port number Interval of transmission for e-RDS 3rd party
Range of settings
1% to 99% 2 to 99 item 1 to 99 lines 1 to 60 sec 1 to 60 sec 0 to 9999 (10 msec) 0 to 9999 (10 msec) 500 to 3000 (10 msec) 0 to 999 0 to 9 0 to 999 0 to 999 0 to 999 0 to 999 0 to 999 0 to 999 0 to 7 10 to 20 0 to 20 (120/230V) 0 to 999 20 (x 10ms)
T-8-28
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Numerical Parameter Composition
8-14
8
Details
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Details
8-15
<002:RTN transmission condition (1)><003: RTN transmission condition (2)><004: RTN transmission condition (3)>
Use it to set RTN signal transmission conditions. Raise these parameters for more lenient conditions if errors occur frequently at time of reception because of transmission of the RTN signal. MEMO: Any of the following error codes may be indicated at time of reception because of RTN signal transmission ##0104, ##0107, ##0114, ##0201 RTN signal transmission condition (1) affects the ratio of error lines to the total number of lines per single page of received images. RTN signal transmission condition (2) affects the standard value (*2) of burst errors (*1). RTN signal condition (3) affects the number of errors not reaching the standard value of burst errors. *1: transmission error occurring cover several lines. *2: for instance, if '15' is set, a single burst error will represent an error occurring continuously cover 15 lines. If any of these lines is detected while an image signal is being received, the RTN signal will be transmitted after receiving the protocol signal of the transmitting party. Higher parameters restrict the transmission of the RTN signal.
MEMO: Any of the following error codes may be indicated because of the condition of the line ##0005, ##0018 The line condition identification time is between when the dial signal is transmitted and when the line condition is cut for the transmitting party, while it is between when the DIS signal is transmitted and when the line is cut for the receiving party.
<017: pseudo RBT signal pattern ON time length/018: pseudo RBT signal pattern OFF time length (short)/019: pseudo RBT signal pattern OFF time length (long)>
Use it to set the pattern of the pseudo RBT signal transmitted at time of a fax/tel switchover.
<020: pseudo CI signal pattern ON time length/021: pseudo CI signal pattern OFF time length (short)/022: pseudo CI signal pattern OFF time length (long)>
Use it to set the pseudo CI signal pattern transmitted at time of a fax/tel switchover.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Details
8-15
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Details
8-16
900s: transmitted scan Guide to the Table - 1:Count sheets of all sizes by one. - 2:Count sheets of the large size by two. - C:full color - Bk:black mono - L:large size (larger than A4/LTR) - S:small size (A4/LTR or smaller)
MEMO: To make a change so that B4 papers (for print) will be counted as large-size, use service mode: make the following selections, and change bit 0 to '1': #SSSW>SW33. To make a change so that B4 papers (for scan) will be counted as large-size, use service mode: make the following selections, and change bit 2 to '1': #SSSW>SW33. Serial Counter type No. on counter check screen Print system Bk 1-sided L Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print Bk 1-sided S Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print Bk 2-sided L Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print Bk 2-sided S Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print
Total1 Total2 Total (L) Total (S) Total (Bk1) Total (Bk2) Total (Bk/L) Total (Bk/S) Total1 (2-sided) Total2 (2-sided) L (2-sided) S (2-sided) TotalA1 TotalA2 TotalA (L) TotalA (S) TotalA (Bk1) TotalA (Bk2)
1 2 1 1 2 1
1 2 1 1 2 1
1 2 1 1 2 1
1 2 1 1 2 1
1 1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
1 2 1 1 2
1 2 1 1 2
1 2 1 1 2
1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Details
8-16
8
Serial Counter type No. on counter check screen Print system Bk 1-sided L Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print Bk 1-sided S Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Details
8-17
Print system Bk 1-sided L Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print Bk 1-sided S Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print Bk 2-sided L Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print Bk 2-sided S Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print
136 137 138 139 140 141 150 151 152 153 156 157 160 161 162 163 164 165 201 202 203 204 205 206 207 208 209 210 211 212 221 222 227 228 237 238 249
TotalA (Bk/L) TotalA (Bk/S) TotalA1 (2-sided) TotalA2 (2-sided) L A (2-sided) S A (2-sided) TotalB1 TotalB2 TotalB (L) TotalB (S) TotalB (Bk1) TotalB (Bk2) TotalB (Bk/L) TotalB (Bk/S) TotalB1 (2-sided) TotalB2 (2-sided) LB (2-sided) SB (2-sided) Copy(Total1) Copy(Total2) Copy(L) Copy(S) CopyA (Total1) CopyA (Total2) CopyA (L) CopyA (S) Local copy(Total1) Local copy(Total2) Local copy(L) Local copy(S) Copy(Bk1) Copy(Bk2) Copy(Bk/L) Copy(Bk/S) Copy(Bk/L/2-sided) Copy(Bk/S/2-sided) CopyA (Bk1)
1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
1 2 1 1 2 1
1 2 1 1 2 1
1 2 1 1 2 1
1 1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
250 255 256 265 266 277 278 283 284 293 294 301 302 303 304 305 306 307 308 313 314 319 320 329 330 331 332 333 334 339 340 345 346 355 356
1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
CopyA (Bk2) CopyA (Bk/L) CopyA (Bk/S) CopyA (Bk/L/2-sided) CopyA (Bk/S/2-sided) Local copy(Bk1) Local copy(Bk2) Local copy(Bk/L) Local copy(Bk/S) Local copy(Bk/L/2sided) Local copy(Bk/S/2sided) Print (Total1) Print (Total2) Print (L) Print (S) PrintA (Total1) PrintA (Total2) PrintA (L) PrintA (S) Print (Bk1) Print (Bk2) Print (Bk/L) Print (Bk/S) Print (Bk/L Print (Bk/S/2-sided) PDLprint (Total1) PDL print (Total2) PDL print (L) PDL print (S) PDL print (Bk1) PDL print (Bk2) PDL print (Bk/L) PDL print (Bk/S) PDL print (Bk/L/2sided) PDL print (Bk/S)
2 1
1 1 1 1
1 2 1
1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Details
8-17
8
Serial Counter type No. on counter check screen Print system Bk 1-sided L Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print Bk 1-sided S Local copy PDL print FAX print Report print
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Details
8-18
Scan system Bk 1-sided L Total scan E-mail scan FileShare DBscan E-mail FileShare DB scan Bk 1-sided S FileShare DB BoxF scan E-mail FileShare DB Box Total scan Total scan Bk 2-sided L E-mail scan FileShare DB scan E-mail FileShare DB scan FileShare DB scan Bk 2-sided S E-mail FileShare DB BOX scan Total scan
403 404 405 406 411 412 413 414 421 422 701 702 703 704 709 710 715 716 725 726 801 802 803 804 809 810 815 816 825 826
Copy+Print (Bk/L) Copy+Print (Bk/S) Copy+Print (Bk2) Copy+Print (Bk1) Copy+Print (L) Copy+Print (S) Copy+Print (2) Copy+Print (1) Copy+Print (Bk/L) Copy+Print (Bk/S) Recieved print (Total1) Recieved print (Total2) Recieved print (L) Recieved print (S) Recieved print (Bk1) Recieved print (Bk2) Recieved print (Bk/L) Recieved print (Bk/S) Recieved print (Bk/L/2sided) Recieved print (Bk/ S/2-sided) Report print (Total1) Report print (Total2) Report print (L) Report print (S) Report print (Bk1) Report print (Bk2) Report print (Bk/L) Report print (Bk/S) Report print (Bk/L) Report print (Bk/S)
1 2 1 1 2 1
1 2 1 1 2 1
1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 501 505 506 507 508 509 510 511 512 915 916 917 1 1 918 921 922 929 930 945 1 1
T-8-29
Scan (Total1) Bk scan (Total1) Bk scan (Total2) Bk scan (L) Bk scan (S) C scanTotal (1) C scanTotal (2) C scan (L) C scan (S) Transmission scan total2 (C) Transmission scan total2 (Bk) Transmission scan total3 (C) Transmission scanTotal3 (Bk) Transmission scanTotal5 (C) Transmission scanTotal5 (Bk) Transmission scanTotal6 (C) Transmission scanTotal6 (Bk) Transmission scan/ E-mail (C)
1 1 2 1
1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
T-8-30
1 1 1
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #NUMERIC > Details
8-18
8
#SCAN
Setting of Scanner Functions (SCANNER)
Item1 No.
#SCAN SW #SCAN 001: - 032: 033: NUMERIC 034: 035: - 046: 047: 048: 049: - 192: 193:
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > Setting of Scanner Functions (SCANNER)
8-19
Item1
Item2
Item3
CCD
Item4
TARGET-B TARGET-G TARGET-R OFST OFST-B OFST-G OFST-R OFST-O OFST-E GAIN GAIN-B GAIN-G GAIN-R GAIN-O GAIN-E R-CON FEEDER
READER DISPLAY
Initial setting
50 50 50 50 0
Appropriate guideline
Description
Not used Vertical scan magnification correction (scanning on BOOK) Horizontal scan magnification correction (scanning on BOOK) Not used Vertical scan magnification correction (scanning on ADF) Horizontal scan magnification correction (scanning on ADF) Not used ADF special paper, standardized size: LGL misidentification-ready
194: 195:
0 0
196: - 290:
0: LEGAL 1: FOOLSCAP 2: M_OFICIO 3: A_FOOLSCAP 4: FOLIO 5: G_LEGAL 6: A_OFICIO 7: B_OFICIO 8: OFICIO 9: E_OFICIO 0: LTR 1: G_LTR 2: A_LTR 0: LTR_R 1: FOOLSCAP 2: OFFICIO 3: E_OFFICIO 4: G_LTR_R 5: A_LTR_R
IO
ADJUST
ADJ-XY ADJ-X
20
ADF special paper, standardized size: LTR misidentification-ready ADF special paper, standardized size: LTR_R misidentification-ready
ADJ-Y ADJ-S
0 75
ADJ-Y-DF
Not used
T-8-31
Target value of shading for blue Target value of shading for green Target value of shading for red Adjustment value of offset level on CIS not used not used not used not used not used Adjustment value of gain level on CIS not used not used not used not used not used Firmware version of reader controller PCB ROM version of DADF controller PCB 1 to 211, Adjustment of scanning system 1=0.1mm image lead edge position (image's scan-start position in vertical scanning direction) -25 to +25, Adjustment value of image 1=0.1mm scan-start position <Y-direction> 25 to 500, Adjustment of CCD/CIS scan1=0.1mm start cell position (image scanstart position in horizontal scanning direction) -25 to +25, Adjustment of horizontal 1=0.1mm scanning position at feeder mode 1 to 200 Adjustment of CCD/CIS scan position at stream-reading mode with DF -10 to +10, Fine adjustment of magnification 1=0.1% ration in vertical scanning when scanning with reader copyboard
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > Setting of Scanner Functions (SCANNER)
8-19
8
Item1 Item2 Item3
CCD
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > Setting of Scanner Functions (SCANNER)
8-20
not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used -128 to 128 Density adjustment at test print scanning Auto adjustment of CCD/CIS reading position in stream reading Gain adjustment of analog processor block. ADF white level adjustment (platen board cover scan/stream reading scan) ADF white level adjustment (platen board cover scan/stream reading scan) not used ADF white level adjustment (platen board cover scan) ADF white level adjustment (DF scan) Clearing of the backup area for the reader in the main controller. Executing activation of the scanning lamp
Item4
W-PLT-X W-PLT-Y W-PLT-Z SH-TRGT
READER ADJUST
Item1
Item2
Item3
CCD
Item4
50_RG 50_GB 100_RG 100_GB 50DF_RG 50DF_GB 100DF_RG 100DF_GB DFTAR-R 292 DFTAR-G DFTAR-B 297 294
CCD-CHNG DFTAR-K 293 MTF3-M1 MTF3-M2 MTF3-M3 MTF3-M4 MTF3-M5 MTF3-M6 MTF3-M7 MTF3-M8 MTF3-M9 MTF3-M10 MTF3-M11 MTF3-M12 MTF3-S1 MTF3-S2 MTF3-S3 MTF3-S4 MTF3-S5 MTF3-S6 MTF3-S7 MTF3-S8 MTF3-S9 MTF3-S10
1 to 2047
White label data entry with standard white plate White label data (Y) entry with standard white plate White label data (Z) entry with standard white plate Shading target value of the standard white plate (backup) not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used Shading target value (RED) entry when using DF (normal document scanning position) Shading target value (GREEN) entry when using DF (normal document scanning position) Shading target value (BLUE) entry when using DF (normal document scanning position) not used Black shading target value when using DF not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used not used
READER ADJUST
PSCAL
MTF3-S11 MTF3-S12 MTF4-M1 MTF4-M2 MTF4-M3 MTF4-M4 MTF4-M5 MTF4-M6 MTF4-M7 MTF4-M8 MTF4-M9 MTF4-M10 MTF4-M11 MTF4-M12 MTF4-S1 MTF4-S2 MTF4-S3 MTF4-S4 MTF4-S5 MTF4-S6 MTF4-S7 MTF4-S8 MTF4-S9 MTF4-S10 MTF4-S11 MTF4-S12 OFST-P-K 0
FUNCTION INSTALL STRD-POS CCD CCD-ADJ DF-WLVL1 DF-WLVL2 MTF-CLC DF-WLVL3 DF-WLVL4 CLEAR R-CON
MISC-R SCANLAMP
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > Setting of Scanner Functions (SCANNER)
8-20
8
Item1 Item2 Item3
BODY
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > Numeric Parameter Settings (Numeric Prama.)
8-21
Item4
SENS-CNF
READER OPTION
0 to 255 0 to 255
FEEDER ADJUST
-50 to 50 -30 to 30
FUNCTION FEEDCHK CL-CHK CL-ON FAN-CHK FAN-ON SL-CHK SL-ON MTR-ON ROLLCLN FEEDON
Setting of the document detection sensor placement not used not used Dirt detection level adjustment (between documents) during ADF use Dirt detection level adjustment (upon job completion) during ADF use not used not used Adjusting the original stop position for ADF pickup (original tray pickup) Adjusting the original feeding speed in stream reading Correcting the paper length in extra length/indeterminate mode with ADF Checking the passage of paper for ADF not used not used Checking the ADF cooling fan Starting the fan operation Checking the ADF solenoid Starting the solenoid operation Starting the motor operation ADF roller cleaning mode Checking the passage of paper with ADF
T-8-32
<047: Vertical scan magnification correction (when scanning on a document fed from ADF)>
Correct the magnification of vertical scanning of a document fed from the ADF. The larger the adjustment value, the more the image stretches in the vertical scanning direction.
<048: Horizontal scan magnification correction (when scanning on a document fed from ADF)>
Correct the magnification of horizontal scanning of a document fed from the ADF. The smaller the adjustment value, the more the image stretches in the horizontal scanning direction.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > Numeric Parameter Settings (Numeric Prama.)
8-21
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > READER
8-22
READER
(#SCAN> READER> DISPLAY> CCD> TARGET-B)
Target value of shading for blue If the scanned image has some failure, check the target value of shading for blue. If the machine continues to display 0 (minimum) or FFFF (maximum), there may be some problem on main controller PCB. Appropriate guideline :1 to 2047 Bit
Bit0 Bit1 Bit2 Bit3 Bit4 Bit5 Bit6 Bit7 Bit8-15
Name
Copyboard cover open/closed sensor (rear) (S32) CCD HP sensor (S31) Not used. Copyboard cover open/closed sensor (front) (S33) Document size snsor 0 (S34) Document size snsor 1 (S35) Document size snsor 2 (S36) Document size snsor 3 (S37) Not used.
Display contents
1: Open 1: HP 1: Open 1: Document present 1: Document present 1: Document present 1: Document present 1: Document present
Remarks
ADF open angle: 5 degrees
T-8-33
Name
Document tray width sensor 2 (PI2)
Display contents
1: Document present
Remarks
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > READER
8-22
8
Bit
Bit1 Bit2 Bit3 Bit4 Bit5 Bit6 Bit7 Bit8 Bit9 Bit10 Bit11 Bit12 Bit13
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > READER
8-23
Name
Document tray width sensor 1 (PI1) Not used. Not used. Delivery reversal sensor (PI6) Read sensor (PI7) Not used. Registration sensor (PI8) Document length sensor 2 (PI5) Document length sensor 1 (PI4) Not used. Cover open/closed sensor (PI10) Last document detection sensor (PI3) Document set sensor (PI11)
Display contents
1: Document present
Remarks
Adjust the position to measure data for shading correction with standard white plate. This item must not be normally used. Note: Be sure to enter the value on service label when replacing the CIS unit. If changing the setting value of this item, be sure to Note the changed value on the service label.
1: Document present 1: Document present 1: Document present 1: Document present 1: Document present 1: Open 1: Document present 1: Document present
T-8-34
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > READER
8-23
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > READER
8-24
Note: Be sure to enter the value on service label when executing RAM clear of the reader controller PCB/ replacing the reader controller PCB. If changing the setting value of this item, be sure to Note the changed value on the reader's service label.l.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > READER
8-24
8
ADF white level adjustment (platen board cover scan). MEMO: Scan a blank sheet on the platen and adjust the white level.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > READER
8-25
Reduce the value if users complain because the cleaning instruction screen which appears when dirt is detected is displayed frequently. Conversely, if the value is reduced too much, black streaks may appear on the images. When '0' is set, the correction control function used when dirt is detected is canceled.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SCAN > READER
8-25
8
(#SCAN> FEEDER> FUNCTION> FAN-ON)
Starting the fan operation. Selecting 1 starts fan operation.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > Numerin Parameter Settings (Numeric Prama).
8-26
#PRINT
Numerin Parameter Settings (Numeric Prama).
#PRINT SW01- SW13 00000100 NUMERIC SW14: SW15: SW17: SW18: 00000100 SW19: - 50: #PRINT 01: - 30: 100 '-128 to 127, one NUMERIC 34: unit = 0.1 mm 35: 100 '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm 36: 100 '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm 37: 100 '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm 38: 100 '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm 39: - 52: 53: 25 0 to 9999, one unit = 0.1 mm 54: 25 0 to 9999, one unit = 0.1 mm 55: 25 0 to 9999, one unit = 0.1 mm 56: 25 0 to 9999, one unit = 0.1 mm 57: 58: 145 '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm 59: 163 '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm 60: 61: 145 '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm 62: 7 0 to 14 63: 64: 65: 66: 67:- 135: 136: 137:- 139: 140: 7 2 0 0 1000 100
Item
No.
Default
Setting range
Not used Special mode setting Not used Special mode setting Not used Not used Left-end registration adjustment (manual feed tray) Left-end registration adjustment (cassette 1) Left-end registration adjustment (cassette 2) Left-end registration adjustment (cassette 3) Left-end registration adjustment (cassette 4) Not used Adjustment of margin at leading edge of copy Adjustment of margin at trailing edge of copy Adjustment of margin at right edge of copy Adjustment of margin at left edge of copy
Function
Not used Adjustment of the registration loop volume (Manual tray) Adjustment of the registration loop volume (Cassette) Not used Adjustment of the registration loop volume (Duplex unit) Temperature adjustment UP/DOWN mode (For normal paper) 0 to 14 Temperature adjustment UP/DOWN mode. (For thick paper) 0 to 4 Mode for preventing the end temperature rise 0 to 2 Mode for reducing sand image 0 to 3 Temperature/ Humidity sensor fixed mode Not used '-512 to 512 Adjustment of the point to start writing in main scanning direction (A) Not used '-128 to 127, one Left-end registration adjustment (doubleunit = 0.1 mm sided small)
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > Numerin Parameter Settings (Numeric Prama).
8-26
8
Item
#PRINT 141: NUMERIC 142: 143: 144: 145: 146: 147: 148: 149: 150: 151: 152: 153: 154: 155: 156: 157: 158:-164: 165: 166: 167: 172: 173: 174: 175:-177: 178: 179: 180:
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > Service Soft Switch Settings (PRINTER)
8-27
Function
No.
Default
100 100 100 100 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 100 100 100 100 100 100 7 0 7 7 0 1 7 7
Adjustment of the magnification to write image in main scanning direction (A-B) '-512 to 511 Not used '-512 to 511 Not used '-512 to 511 Adjustment of the point to start writing in main scanning direction (A-B) '-512 to 511 Not used '-512 to 511 Not used '-128 to 127 Developing bias offset for DC '-128 to 127 Primary charge offset for DC '-128 to 127 Primary charge offset for AC '-128 to 127, one Adjustment of the registration loop volume unit = 0.1 mm (Thick paper) '-128 to 127, one Adjustment of the registration loop volume unit = 0.1 mm (Special paper) '-128 to 127, one Adjustment of the registration loop volume unit = 0.1 mm (Envelop cassette pickup) 0 to 14 Pickup timing adjustment Not used 0 to 3 Fixing auto cleaning frequency setting 0 to 14 Temperature adjustment UP/DOWN mode (Plain paper, manual feed tray) Not used 0 to 14 Temperature adjustment UP/DOWN mode (2nd page of double-sided printing) 0 to 1 Reduction in FCOT Not used 0 to 1 Not used 0 to 14 Temperature adjustment UP/DOWN mode (Envelop/Postcard) 0 to 14 Temperature adjustment UP/DOWN mode (Special mode N)
T-8-35
'-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm '-128 to 127, one unit = 0.1 mm '-512 to 511
Setting range
Left-end registration adjustment (doublesided large) Adjustment of margin at leading edge at normal speed (230mm/sec) Adjustment of margin at leading edge at half speed (137mm/sec) Laser trail edge OFF adjustment
Function
Item1 Item2
#PRINT CAS1 CST
Item3
CAS1-U1 0
CAS2
CAS3
CAS4
26: OFI, 27: E-OFI, 37: M-OFI, Cassette 1paper size 36: A-OFI, 24: FLSP, 25: A-FLSP, group special, standard30: A-LTRR, 42: FA4, 34: G-LGL size paper entry 0: default 32: G-LTR-R, 34: G-LGL, 23: K-LGL-R, 0: default 22: K-LGL, 31: G-LTR, 29: A-LTR, 0: default 28: B-OFI, 0: default 26: OFI, 27: E-OFI, 37: M-OFI, Cassette 2 paper size 36: A-OFI, 24: FLSP, 25: A-FLSP, group special, standard30: A-LTRR, 42: FA4, 34: G-LGL size paper entry 0: default 32: G-LTR-R, 34: G-LGL, 23: K-LGL-R, 0: default 22: K-LGL, 31: G-LTR, 29: A-LTR, 0: default 28: B-OFI, 0: default 26: OFI, 27: E-OFI, 37: M-OFI, Cassette 3paper size 36: A-OFI, 24: FLSP, 25: A-FLSP, group special, standard30: A-LTRR, 42: FA4, 34: G-LGL size paper entry 0: default 32: G-LTR-R, 34: G-LGL, 23: K-LGL-R, 0: default 22: K-LGL, 31: G-LTR, 29: A-LTR, 0: default 28: B-OFI, 0: default 26: OFI, 27: E-OFI, 37: M-OFI, Cassette 4 paper size 36: A-OFI, 24: FLSP, 25: A-FLSP, group special, standard30: A-LTRR, 42: FA4, 34: G-LGL size paper entry 0: default 32: G-LTR-R, 34: G-LGL, 23: K-LGL-R, 0: default 22: K-LGL, 31: G-LTR, 29: A-LTR, 0: default 28: B-OFI, 0: default
T-8-36
Function
Transfer bias pressure reduction mode not used Black belt addition mode Post-rotation reduction mode Flicker reduction mode
1
Enable Enable Enable Enable
0
Disable Disable Disable Disable
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > Service Soft Switch Settings (PRINTER)
8-27
8
Bit
5 6 7
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions
8-28
Function
not used not used not used
1
-
0
T-8-37
SSSW-SW18
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Function
not used not used Thin postcard mode not used not used not used not used not used
1
Enable -
0
Disable T-8-38
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 Select whether to enable or disable transfer bias pressure reduction mode. Select "Enable" to avoid image defects (black spots) produced by transfer bias leaks occurring in a low-pressure region, such as one at a high altitude. This setting regulates the transfer bias to keep it from exceeding a predetermined level during printing. Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 Select whether to enable or disable black belt addition mode. If the user uses paper that causes fixed toner on paper to be fused and adhered to drum, selecting "Yes" will clean the drum by forming a black band on the drum surface during the reverse rotation which is performed after printing on 50 sheets.
Detailed Discussions of Bit 2 When the postcard size is selected, "Thin postcard" can be selected in addition to "Postcard", "Return postcard", and "4 on 1card". Selecting "Enable" allows you to specify "Thin postcard".
List of Functions
<034: Left-end registration adjustment (manual feed tray)>
Adjust the left-end registration margin of paper picked from a manual feed tray. The larger the adjustment value, the wider the left-end margin of the image becomes.
CAUTION: Implementation of this mode could result in a drum life falling short of its life expectancy.
Detailed Discussions of Bit 3 Select whether to enable or disable post-rotation reduction mode. Selecting "Enable" will reduce the noise caused by the polygon motor by stopping the motor immediately after postrotation. Discussions of Bit 4 Select whether to enable or disable flicker reduction mode. Select "Enable" and enter a count to modify fusing temperature control to cancel fluorescent flicking during printing.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions
8-28
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions
8-29
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions
8-29
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions
8-30
2. Fixed environment of NN. (Temperature of 18-28 deg C and humidity of 20-75%) 3. Fixed environment of HH. (Temperature of 28 deg C and humidity of 80%)
direction (A-B)>
When replacing the laser, enter the delay value (laser main scanning adjustment).
<136: Adjustment of the point to start writing in laser's main scanning direction (A)>
When replacing the laser unit, enter the unit-specific delay value shown on the label affixed to the unit.
<145: Adjustment of the magnification to write image in laser's main scanning direction (A-B)>
Magnification between lasers A and B. Amount of adjustment of the magnification of laser B of the laser scanner unit. Adjust the magnification of laser B with reference to that of laser A. If the input value is inappropriate, the image quality is degraded.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions
8-30
8
<165: Fixing auto cleaning frequency setting>
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions(PRINT CST)
8-31
Use this parameter to increase the fixing auto cleaning frequency. Incrementing the value increases the fixing auto cleaning frequency. 0: Not cleaned. 1: Cleaning control temperature: 225C, Cleaning time: 60 sec, Cleaning interval: 500 sheets 2: Cleaning control temperature: 225C, Cleaning time: 60 sec, Cleaning interval: 200 sheets 3: Cleaning control temperature: 225C, Cleaning time: 60 sec, Cleaning interval: 100 sheets
<166: Temperature adjustment UP/DOWN mode (Plain paper, manual feed tray)>
The temperature adjustment offset relative to the target fixing temperature of plain paper fed from the manual feed paper can be changed in steps of 3C. Use this parameter when the fixing performance is low or when it is necessary to prevent the paper from slipping or being curled. Plain paper: Plain paper mode, thin paper mode, S thin paper mode, OHP mode 0 - 2:+15C 3 - 11:12 - -15C (in steps of 3C) 12 - 14:-15C
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions(PRINT CST)
8-31
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions(PRINT CST)
8-32
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #PRINT > List of Functions(PRINT CST)
8-32
8
#NETWORK
Confirmation of contents of CA certificate
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SYSTEM > Details of Bit Switch
8-33
#SYSTEM
Configuration
Item No. Default
11001000 00000000 00000000
Selecting the service mode "#NETWORK>#CERTIFICATE>#CA-CERTIFICATE" enables confirmation of the contents of the installed CA certificate.
Description
Not used Inhibition of export of password in address book Not used Forced invalidity of uniFLOW PS data protocol menu display/nondisplay Extra length setting Not used
#CODEC
Configuration
Item
#BitSwitch #Numeric
#SYSTEM SW SW01- SW04 SW05 SW06- SW08 SW9 SW10 SW11 - SW50
No.
SW01- SW09 01: - 05: 06:
Default
Item
#SYSTEM NUMERIC
No.
01: - 38: 39: 40: 41: 42: 43: - 56: 57: 58: - 100:
Default
4 1 0 0 0
T-8-40
0-3
1-7
Details
06: Control of attribute flag addition function at reception and printing of color JPEG or E-mail image
Set the type of the attribute flag to be added at reception of a color JPEG or E-mail image. 0: For PDL_text mode 1: For PDL_photo mode 2: For scan_text mode 3: For scan_photo mode
Not used Change of default of LDAP advanced search condition eLA card touch sound PS mode 1 (8bit) PS mode 2 (8bit) Not used Setting of paper size group Not used
T-8-41
Function
1
Inhibited
0
Not inhibited
T-8-42
Detailed Discussions of Bit 7 Select whether to inhibit export of the password in the address book.
SW09
List of Functions
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #SYSTEM > Details of Bit Switch
8-33
8
Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #ACC > Configuration
8-34
Function
1
ON
0
OFF
T-8-43
Detailed Discussions of Bit 3 Select whether to set the forced invalidity of uniFLOW.
SW10
List of Functions Bit
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Function
PS data protocol menu display/nondisplay Extra length setting
1
Display ON -
0
Nondisplay OFF T-8-44
#ACC
Configuration
The table below gives summary description of the accessories available. Item1
#ACC
Item2
CARD
Explanation
Detailed Discussions of Bit 0 Select whether to inhibit export of the password in the address book. Detailed Discussions of Bit 1 Select whether to set the extra length (expand the user-defined size range).
CC-SPSW
COIN
CONTROL
Card reader installation setting Enter a card number to use. (0 to 9999. One hundred cards are registered with the department ID beginning from the input card number in sequence.) *1:1,000 cards if option ROM is mounted. When a card number is entered, the following kinds of management information are initialized: - Card name (department ID), beginning from the input card number. - Password associated with the card Control card I/F support setting Set whether to support the control card I/F (CC-V) or not. 0: Do not support. 1: Support. Coin vendor change Set the control card set display appearing on the operator station for vendor use. 0: Control card use 1: Coin vendor use Set the PDL printer output control where the control card I/F (CC-V) is supported. 0: Enable printing without a card mounted. 1: Enable printing with a card mounted in position.
T-8-45
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #ACC > Configuration
8-34
8
#COUNTER
Counters
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #COUNTER > Clearing Counters
8-35
Service life
150,000 150,000 500,000 150,000 150,000 iR2545/2535: 240,000 iR2530/2525/2520: 150,000" 80,000 250-sheet 1st cassette type: 150,000 250-sheet 1st cassette type: 120,000 150,000 120,000 120,000 (250-sheet 1st cassette type only) 120,000 80,000 80,000 120,000 120,000 120,000 120,000 500,000
T-8-47
This copier is furnished with a maintenance/supplies counter set (DRBL-1), which can be used to gain rough measures of when to replace supplies. The counter set increments by one on counting each sheet of small-sized paper (up to A4/LTR) and by two on counting each sheet of large-sized paper (larger than A4/LTR). Maintenance counter list Item
TOTAL (Total counter)
Counter
Explanation
Service total counter 1 Service total counter 2 Total counter Total copy counter PDL print counter Fax print counter Media print counter Report print counter Double-sided copy/print counter Scan counter Cassette 1 jam counter Cassette 2 jam counter Cassette 3 jam counter Cassette 4 jam counter Manual feed tray pickup total counter Double-sided paper pickup total counter Feeder pickup total counter ADF open/close hinge counter Finisher sort path counter Finisher saddle operation counter Finisher saddle staple operation counter Unit total jam count Feeder total jam count Finisher total jam count Duplex unit jam counter Manual feed tray jam counter Cassette 1 jam counter Cassette 2 jam counter Cassette 3 jam counter Cassette 4 jam counter Waste toner counter
T-8-46
SERVICE1 SERVICE2 TTL COPY PDL-PRT FAX-PRT MEDIA-PRT RPT-PRT 2-SIDE SCAN PICK-UP (Paper pickup counter) C1 C2 C3 C4 MF 2-SIDE FEEDER (Feeder related counters) FEED DFOP-CNT SORTER (Finisher related counters) SORT SADDLE SDL-STPL JAM (Jam counters) TTL FEEDER SORTER 2-SIDE MF C1 C2 C3 C4 MISC (Other required counter) WST-TNR
Photosensitive drum rotation count Waste toner count Cassette1 pickup roller paper pass count
C2-PU-RL C1-SP-RL C1-SP-PD C2-SP-RL OZ-FIL1 DRBL-2 (Unit DF-PU-RL supplies) DF-SP-PD C3-PU-RL C4-PU-RL C3-SP-RL C4-SP-RL FIN-STPR
Cassette2 pickup roller paper pass count Cassette1 separation roller paper pass count Cassette1 separation pad paper pass count Cassette2 separation roller paper pass count not used ADF pickup roller paper pass count ADF separation pad paper pass count Cassette3 pickup roller paper pass count Cassette4 pickup roller paper pass count Cassette3 separation roller paper pass count Cassette4 separation roller paper pass count Stapler assembly drive count
Clearing Counters
Maintenance/parts counter all clear Execute service mode > CLEAR > COUNTER to clear all maintenance/parts counters. Counter clear on parts replacement Press the numeric keypad key 0 after displaying the counter for a part just replaced, and the counter will be cleared individually.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #COUNTER > Clearing Counters
8-35
8
#LMS
Configuration
INACTIVE
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #LMS > Details
8-36
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
ERASE
Group
Item
Default
Group
ST-SEND 0 TR-SEND ST-BRDIM 0 TR-BRDIM ST-ERDS 0 TR-ERDS ST-PCL TR-PCL ST-EAM TR-EAM ST-ELA TR-ELA ST-SPDF 0 TR-SPDF ST-PS TR-PS 0 0 0 0
Item
Default
0-1
0-1
0-1
0-1
0-1
0-1
0-1
0-1
To display installation state of SEND function when transfer is displayed. The 24 digits of license transfer numbers are displayed. To display installation state of BarDIMM when transfer is disabled. The 24 digits of license transfer numbers are displayed. To display installation state of third party expansion function of E-RDS when transfer is disabled. The 24 digits of license transfer numbers are displayed. To display installation state of PCL function when transfer is disabled. The 24 digits of license transfer numbers are displayed. To display installation state of EAM function when transfer is disabled. The 24 digits of license transfer numbers are displayed. To display installation state of ELA function when transfer is disabled. The 24 digits of license transfer numbers are displayed. To display installation state of transmission function for SEND searchable PDF when transfer is disabled. The 24 digits of license transfer numbers are displayed. To display installation state of PS function when transfer is disabled The 24 digits of license transfer numbers are displayed.
To display installation state of SEND function when non-transfer is displayed. To display installation state of BarDIMM when non-transfer is disabled. To display installation state of third party expansion function of E-RDS when non-transfer is disabled. To display installation state of PCL function when non-transfer is disabled. To display installation state of EAM function when non-transfer is disabled. To display installation state of ELA function when non-transfer is disabled. To display installation state of transmission function for SEND searchable PDF when nontransfer is disabled. To display installation state of PS function when non-transfer is disabled
T-8-48
Outline
1. Validate an optional function which has been installed but has not been validated based on the license key issued by a license issue server (hereinafter called "LMS"). 2. Invalidate the function for which a license has been already set up.
Details
1. Validate a license by entering the license issued by LMS via the local UI. 2. The license key issued by LMS cannot be entered via the remote UI. 3. Invalidate a license (Set the function to OFF) via the service mode. 4. Validate a license via the service mode. 5. A license with restriction (with an expiration date, restriction in the number of licenses) is not supported. (Restriction information is not read.) 6. Some optional functions installed are in dependent relationship with each other. For example, when using [Function A], [Function B] should be available. In this case, [Function B] is called a slave option of [Function A]. Installation of the slave option fails when it is
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #LMS > Details
8-36
8
relationship. 7. Decoding and verifying a license key
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #LMS > Inactivity of the transmitted license
8-37
Status/Optional Setting
ON/ON ON/ON
T-8-49
found that the master option is not validated as a result of verification of the dependent
Item Name
Color Universal SEND KIT
License Name
BW-SEND CL-SEND
Decode an entered license key and examine the validity of the license information obtained. When an error occurs during verification, the error information is sent back to the local UI, which displays an error message based on the information.Verification errors are assumed to occur in the following cases. - When a license is installed in a non-licensed device - When an optional function included in the license does not exist in the target device - When an optional function included in the license is a slave option and a master option is not validated - When an incorrect license key is entered - When a license key is illegally altered
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #LMS > Inactivity of the transmitted license
8-37
8
#SEND 001 OK 1
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #LMS > Erasing a License
8-38
1: The function is validated. 2: The function is invalidated, or the license is transferred. 3: The function is invalidated, or the license does not exist. (8) When you contact the contact section of the sales company and report a function
F-8-5
invalidation certificate key required for license transfer, the serial number of the transfer origination device, and the serial number of the transfer destination device, a new license key that can be registered to the transfer destination device is issued. (9) Register the new license key to the transfer destination device and make sure that the function is validated.
(6) Press 2 using the numeric key and press the OK key.
The 24 digits of license transfer numbers are displayed, so you take the memo. Because it cannot maintain the number displaying with the thing of this place limit. If you do not take the memo, the indication contents are not held when you do OFF of the main power, it is impossible for license transfer. Even if you push the reset key and clear the indication, the indication is never display again.
Erasing a License
Erasing a License When you invalidate a license option on a temporary basis or when you do not use it for a long period of time, you can invalidate the function by erasing the license. The license can be validated by registering the license number again.
Procedure to erase a license You can erase a license by entering the service mode.
Operation Procedure: (1) Enter the service mode and display the following service mode. When you have entered the service mode, use the right and left arrow keys to display items,and press the OK key to fix the setting. (2) Display [#LMS]. (3) Press the OK key and display [#LMS ERASE].
F-8-6
OK
(7) Turn OFF/ON the power of the main unit. For Reference: When a license option is displayed in Procedure (4), 001 1 is displayed. The last "1" shows that the license is validated by license authentication. After the license is transferred, the last number is changed to "2". When the option is standard, the last number shows "3" which means disable for license
(4) Display [SEND]. (5) Press the OK key. (6) Turn OFF/ON the power of the main unit. For Reference: There is no function to display the license registration numbers in the main unit. Therefore, when there is a possibility to restore the license after erasing it, make sure that a user has written down the license registration number.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #LMS > Erasing a License
8-38
8
that the license is validated by license authentication. After the license is erased, the last number is changed to "2".
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #E-RDS > Configuration
8-39
When a license option is displayed in Procedure (4), 001 1 is displayed. The last "1" shows
#E-RDS
Configuration
Settings related to e-RDS are described below. Item
E-RDS SWITCH RGWADDRESS 0
When the option is standard, the last number shows "3" which means disable for license transfer. Details about the last number: 1: The function is validated. 2: The function is invalidated, or a license is transferred. 3: The function is invalidated, or the license does not exist.
Default
0 or 1
Setting range
URL of UGW Character string length:129byte (including NULL, one-byte codes only) 1-65535
e-RDS OFF/ON setting (0:OFF / 1:ON)When used (ON), the counter information and error information are sent to UGW.Default: 0 (OFF) URL of UGWDefault: URL of actual UGWCharacter string length: 129 bytes (including NULL, one-byte codes only) Port No. of UGW Default: 443Setting range: 1 to 65535 Setting of the date of sending the counter information to the server (Valid after input of license). Set the start date of the schedule to send the counter information to the server using a third party expansion function of E-RDS. Refer to the user mode date setting. (12 digits: YYYYMMDDHHMM) YYYY: Year MM: Month DD: Day HH: Hour MM: Minute Setting of the interval of sending the counter information to the server (Valid after input of license). Set the interval of sending the counter information to the server using a third party expansion function of E-RDS. Execution of communication test An attempt is made to connect to UGW, judges whether connection is successful, and displays "COMTEST OK" or "COMTEST NG" as the judgment result. Details of communication test result. The log of errors in communication with UGW is displayed. The error information includes the error occurrence time, error code, and details of the error.Maximum log count: 5Error information length: Max. 128 characters (excluding NULL) Repair completion process (call button function) Used when the service personnel has completed the requested repair.
T-8-50
Description
CNT-INTV
24
COM-TEST
COM-LOG
SCALLCMP
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #E-RDS > Configuration
8-39
8
#REPORT
Configuration
The table below lists the kinds of reports that are supported. Item
SERVICE DATA LIST
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #REPORT > Details
8-40
Details
System Data List
Use it to check the settings associated with the service soft switch and service parameters. Explanation
"Service mode service soft switch output (SSSW, MENU, NUMERIC Param., SPECIAL, NCU, SCAN, PRINT, SYSTEM, ROM, start date)" "Service mode service soft switch output (SSSW, MENU, NUMERIC Param., SPECIAL, NCU, SCAN, PRINT, SYSTEM, ROM, start date) System dump list output" Transmission count, reception count, record chart count, error count and other outputs Counter output Jam and error history output Type setting, print speed, memory size, ROM indication, adjustment data and other outputs Not used. Output of communication error log information related to e-RDS
T-8-51
001
#SSSW SW01 SW02 SW03 SW04 SW05 SW06 SW07 SW08 SW09 SW10 SW11 SW12 SW13 SW14 SW15 SW16 SW17 SW18 SW19 SW20 SW21 SW22 SW23 SW24 SW25 SW26 SW27 SW28 SW29 SW30 SW31 SW32 SW33 SW34 SW35 SW36 SW37 SW38 SW39 SW40 SW41 SW42 SW43 SW44 SW45 SW46 SW47 SW48 SW49 SW50 #MENU 01: 02: 03: 04: 05: --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------00000000 10000000 00000000 10000000 00000000 10000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000011 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00011000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00100000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
SYSTEM DUMP LIST COUNTER LIST ERROR LOG LIST SPEC LIST SERVICE LABEL ERDS COM LOG LIST
---------------------
0 0 0 0 0
F-8-7
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #REPORT > Details
8-40
8
System Dump List
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #REPORT > Details
8-41
7 3 0 0
T-8-52
*1 *2 *3 *4 *5
#1 LATEST
JPEG
*6 *7
*8 *8
MCF DCN
[9]
#2 START TIME OTHER PARTY MAKER CODE MACHINE CODE RCV V.8 FRAME SYMBOL RATE DATA RATE TX LVL REDUCTION ERR ABCODE ERR SECTXB ERR SECRXB Rx : ( bit ( bit Tx : ( bit ( bit 1) 57 ) 1) 57 )
#000 09/02 09:30 12345678 10001000 0100001 00000000 E0 81 85 D4 90 7E 00 00 3429 baud 28800 bps [V. 34] 0 00 00 00 01110111 01011111 00000001 00000100 01000010 00011111 00000001 00000100 00100011 00000001 10101001 00000001 ( bit 00000000 00000000 ( bit 00100001 00000001 00000001 00000001 ( bit 00000000 00000000 ( bit 56 ) 96 ) 56 ) 96 )
F-8-8
*1: TX, number of total pages transmission. *2: Total number of pages transmitted/received according to original size. *3: RX, number of total pages reception. *4: Total number of pages transmitted and received for each modem speed. *5: Total number of pages transmitted/received in connection with different modem speeds (Standard, Fine, Super Fine, Ultra Fine). *6: Total number of pages transmitted and received for each coding method. *7: Total number of pages transmitted and received in each mode . *8: Total number of pages printed/scanned. *9: Total number of occurrences for error code .
MCF DCN
#3 OLDEST START TIME OTHER PARTY MAKER CODE MACHINE CODE RCV V.8 FRAME SYMBOL RATE DATA RATE TX LVL REDUCTION ERR ABCODE ERR SECTXB ERR SECRXB
#000 09/02 09:00 12345678 10001000 0100001 00000000 E0 81 85 D4 90 7E 00 00 3429 baud 28800 bps [V. 34] 0 00 00 00
F-8-9
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #REPORT > Details
8-41
8
*1: service error code. *2: START TIME, date and time (in 24-hr notation). *3: OTHER PARTY, telephone number sent by the other party. *4: MAKER CODE, manufacturer code. *5: MACHINE CODE, model code.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #REPORT > Details
8-42
*6: bit 1 through bit 96 of DIS, DCS, or DTC that has been received. *7: bit 1 through bit 96 of DIS, DCS, or DTC that has been transmitted. *8: RX, procedural signal received; TX, procedural signal transmitted.
JAM
[7]
0012
000026 1 A4
Counter List
Explanation: Maintenance/supplies counter output. (For more detailed information about the maintenance/supplies counter output, refer to #COUNTER(page 8-35)..)
20 04/12 12:17 20:03 4 1 0012 000026 1 A4
[4] [5]
[6]
[7]
[8]
F-8-10
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #REPORT > Details
8-42
8
Jam history description (JAM) Item
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] Number Jam date Jam time Jam recovery time Location Occurrence category Jam code Total counter display Pickup stage position Paper size
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #REPORT > Details
8-43
0001 ***************************** *** SPEC REPORT *** ***************************** TYPE LBP SPEED TOTAL MEMORY MAIN OPTION BOOT LANG LANG LIBRARY LANG FILE VIENTNAMESE CHINESE(TRAD. ) TURKISH SWEDISH _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ JAPAN 45cpm 256MB WLaa-07-09 BOOT-V0023 00000010 00000010 00000010 00000010 00000010
Spec List
Explanation
The larger the number of a jam, the more recently it has occurred. Date of jam occurrence
2009 10/09 16:31
3: Host machine, 4: ADF, 5: Finisher 0: Host machine, 1: ADF, 2: Finisher For a definition of the code, see the Jam Code(page 7-11).. 0: Manual feed tray, 1: Cassette 1, 2: Cassette 2, 3: Cassette 3, 4: Cassette 4
T-8-53
[4]
Explanation
The larger the number of an error, the more recently it has occurred. Date of error occurrence
BULGARIAN ECONT OPT-CAS 1 OPT-CAS 2 OPT-CAS 3 OPT-DUP OPT-FIN MEDIA ACTIBAT FUNCTION BDL-IMAGE (1200) FAX NETWORK PCL PC-SCAN BW-SEND CL-SEND PAF BDL-IMAGE (600) E-RDS BAR-DIMM SERCHABLE PDF eAM eLA PS _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ 00000010 0303 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 OFF ON ON ON ON OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF
3: Main unit, 5: Finisher Error code (4-digit code; for a definition of the code, Error Code(page 7-3)..) Detail code of the error code (4-digit code; for a definition of the code, see the "Error Code" Chapter.)
[5]
Explanation
The larger the number of a alarm, the more recently it has occurred. Date of alarm occurrence
F-8-11
Alarm code (4-digit code; for a definition of the code, see the Alarm Code(page 7-15)..) Detail code of the alarm code (8-digit code; for a definition of the code, see the "Error Code" Chapter.)
T-8-55
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #REPORT > Details
8-43
8
07/12/2005 13:07 FAX
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #DOWNLOAD > Download
8-44
002
[6]
[7]
[13]
PARAM TYPE OPTION/ENABLE SW BDL-IMAGE (1200) FAX NETWORK PCL PC-SCAN BW-SEND CL-SEND PAF BDSS BDL-IMAGE (600) COUNTER E-RDS BAR-DIMM SERCHABLE PDF eAM eLA PS BODY No. ENGINE CODE SIZE TYPE PRODUCT NAME TOTAL TTL COPY FAX-PRT PDL-PRT RPT-PRT MEDIA-PRT PICT-PRT TONER-YELLOW TONER-MAGENTA TONER-CYAN TONER-BLACK OPTYION ROM USB MEMORY SD CARD USB SERIAL No. MAC ADDRESS NUMBER OF LOGS ACTIVITY (FAX) ACTIVITY PRINTJOB ACCOUNT COPY PDL PRINT RX PRINT REPORT MEDIA/PICT BRIDGE JAM SERVICE CALL ENVIROMENT ALARM COUNTER
_____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
1 : JP OFF / OFF OFF / OFF OFF / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF ON / OFF FUYxxxxx 20080042 1 : AB XXX 000688 000685 000000 000000 000000 000000 000000 000000 000000 000000 000000 0MB OFF 0MB 00XXXXXXXX 00 00 85 51 60 1C 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 0 ON
USB memory availability SD card volume USB serial number MAC address output the number of histories (communication history, copy/print/report/JOB history of the reception print, jam history, E code history, humidity log) Counter ON/OFF
#DOWNLOAD
Download
The following parts of this unit can be upgraded by executing download mode using the service support tool (UST) (for more information, see the Upgrading Targets and Procedure(page 6-8).): Main unit ROM mounted on the main controller PCB (BOOT+PROGRAM) ROM mounted on the DC controller PCB (DCON) Accessory ROM mounted on the finisher controller PCB(FIN_CON)
[14]
F-8-12
Type setting Print speed Memory size ROM version (MAIN/BOOT/LANG*1(language liblary/language file version)ECONT/option cassette/duplex unit/finisher) Activation function ON/OFF Not used Total counter (TOTAL/COPY/FAX/PDL/REPORT record counts) Option ROM availability
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #DOWNLOAD > Download
8-44
8
#CLEAR
Configuration
Group
TEL & USER DATA
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #DISPLAY > Configuration
8-45
Description
Initializes the ELA Flash/SRAM data. Clears user and service data (except for some scan parameters and print parameters), and the counter setting/registration data in the system dump list, except for the print count.
T-8-56
Group
ELA-DAT ALL
Item
Item
Description
Clears all user-registered and -set areas of telephone registration data and user data. (Telephone registration refers to the registration of codes on one-touch dialing, abbreviated dialing, and group dialing.) SERVICE DATA Clears theservice data. User data is not cleared. COUNTER Clears the maintenance counter, parts counter and mode-specific counters. Initializes the counter (numerator) in the system dump list. SOFT-CNT Not used TYPE Initializes user data and service data to suit specified destination settings. HST ACTIVITY Initializes the activity report ACCOUNT Clears print histories. JAM Clears the jam history. ERR Clear the error (error code) history. ALARM Clears the alarm history. ENVIROMENT Initializes the enviroment log data. CARD Clears department management information held in the controller before the card reader is demounted. ERR E719 Clears card reader errors. PWD Clears the system administrator's password. FILE SYSTEM Not used FORMAT USB MEMORY Format the USB memory. (This mode is used when the USB memory error is damaged and E744 occurs.) LICENSE DRIVE Clears the drive for license file. FMT-SD 512 Format the 512MB SD card. 1024 Format the 1204MB SD card. 2048 Format the 2048MB SD card. CA-KEY Initializes an installed CA certification. (Displayed only after activation of the e-RDS function.) ERDS-DAT The settings related to e-RDS are cleared to the factory settings. (Displayed only after activation of the e-RDS function.) DEPT_USER_CLEAR Turns off the department-based ID management and user management functions. SYSTEM_INFO_CLEAR Clears the system management identification number. ENGIN ERRCLR Clears the engine errors. BKRAMCLR Clears the engine backup RAM. TNRINST Supplies toner from the toner cartridge to the developing assembly. EAM-DAT Initializes the EAM Flash/SRAM data.
#DISPLAY
Configuration
An error code is displayed when a service error has occurred. The E code is displayed in the upper step, and the detail code is displayed the bottom step. Group
DISPLAY
Item
ERR
Description
The E code and detail code of the current system error are displayed. (Multiple codes can be displayed with the left and right buttons. ) <Display example> SYSTEM ERROR xxx: Eyyy-zzzz Example) 001:E602-1105 xxx: History number yyy: E Code zzzz: Detail code The current JAM code is displayed. (Multiple JAM codes can be displayed with the left and right buttons.) <Display example> JAM ERROR xxx:y-z-vvvv-wwww xxx: History number y: Description of position (3: Main unit (including the pickup assembly), 4: ADF, 5: Finisher) z: Cassette level (01: Manual feed tray, 1: Cassette 1, 2: Cassette 2, 3; Cassette 3,4: Cassette 4, 7: Double-sided) vvvv: JAM code wwww: paper size Display of engine speed type on controller PCB <Display example> SPDTYPE (Line 1) 45cpm (Line 2)
T-8-57
JAM
SPDTYPE
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #DISPLAY > Configuration
8-45
8
#ROM
Configuration
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Configuration
8-46
Configuration
Numerals enclosed in parentheses denote a numeric keypad key to be pressed each. Group
TEST MODE [1] - [9] (1) DRAM [1] - [2] (1) D-RAM TEST (2) D-RAM TEST (3) PG SELECT NO.01 SELECT NO.02 SELECT NO.03 SELECT NO.04 SELECT NO.05 SELECT NO.06 SELECT NO.07 SELECT NO.08 SELECT NO.09 (4) MODEM TEST [1] - [9] (1) RELAY TEST [1] - [2] (1) RELAY TEST 1 (2) RELAY TEST 2
The table below lists the items of ROM display mode that are supported. Group
ROM
subgroup Item 1
Item2
Item3
Explanation
D-RAM data check Write/read check Read check Grid HT All-black output ---(For R&D) ---(For R&D) 4dot-6space (vertical) dot-6space (horizontal) ---(For R&D) 16 gray levels (monochromatic)
Item
MAIN (Bootable) MAIN2 (Boot) OPROM ECONT OPTION CAS1 OPTION CAS2 OPTION CAS3 DUPLEX FINISHER READER
Description
Displays the version number of the PROGRAM ROM mounted on the main controller PCB. Displays the version of the ROM (BOOT) mounted on the main controller PCB. Not used Displays the version number of the ROM mounted on the DC controller PCB. Not used Not used Not used Not used Displays the version number of the Inner finisher Not used
T-8-58
#TEST MODE
Outline
Test mode must be executed by keeping track the flow of menu items appearing on the LCD. Menu items in test mode are organized into seven blocks as described below. Numerals enclosed in parentheses denote a numeric keypad key to be pressed each. 1. D-RAM test <(1) D-RAM TEST> Checks to see if data can be correctly written to and read from D-RAM. 2. PG output <(3) PG> Used to generate service test patterns. 3. MODEM test <(4) MODEM TEST> Performs relay actuation, modem DTMF and tonal signal transmission/reception tests. 4. FUNCTION test <(6) FUNCTION TEST> Used to verify the operations of microswitches, sensors, speakers and ADF functions.
(2) FREQ TEST [0] - [6] (0) FREQ TEST 462Hz (1) FREQ TEST 1100Hz (2) FREQ TEST 1300Hz (3) FREQ TEST 1500Hz (4) FREQ TSST 1650Hz (5) FREQ TEST 1850Hz (6) FREQ TEST 2100Hz G3 signal transmission test (4) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST [0] - [8] (0) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 300bps (1) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 2400bps (2) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 4800bps (3) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 7200bps (4) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 9600bps (5) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST TC7200bps (6) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST TC9600bps (7) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 12000bps (8) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 14400bps DTMF transmission test (5) DTMF TEST [0] - [9], * , # (0) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 300bps (1) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 2400bps (2) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 4800bps
NCU relay (and switch) ON/OFF test 230 V common NCU test Frequency test
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Configuration
8-46
8
Group subgroup Item 1 Item2 Item3
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-47
(3) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 7200bps (4) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 9600bps (5) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST TC7200bps (6) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST TC9600bps (7) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 12000bps (8) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 14400bps (9) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST TC9600bps (*) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 12000bps (#) G3 SIGNAL TX TEST 14400bps Tonal sign reception test (6) MODEM TEST V34 G3 signal transmission test (8) G3 V.34 Tx TEST (6) FUNCTION TEST [1] - [9] G3 4800 bps signal transmission test (1) FUNCTION TEST G3 4800bps Sensor checks (2) SENS/SW CHECK Sensor check with flag FLAG Cassette check CST Reader sensor check READER A/D Analog/digital computation output sensor Copy confirmation sensor COPY ADF sensor check ADF cardreader test (3) NCR sts Line signal reception test (9) LINE TEST [1] - [3]
T-8-59
Explanation
Numeric keypad key 2 Checks to see if data can be correctly read from all areas of D-RAM (SDRAM). If an error occurs making this check, the test is aborted, with an error appearing on the touch panel (LCD).
D-RAMTEST [1] - [2] Press numeric keypad key 1 D-RAMTEST 29888KB 29888KBTotal size of D-RAM memory (byte) :Size of written to memory :Size of read from memory
Press numeric keypad key 2 D-RAMTEST 29888KB 29888KBTotal size of D-RAM memory (byte) :Size of read from memory
F-8-13
Details
D-RAM Test <(1) D-RAM>
Press the numeric keypad key 1 on the test mode menu to select the D-RAM test. Press numeric keypad keys 1 and 2 during the D-RAM test to carry out the individual tests described below. Numeric keypad key 1 Checks to see if data can be correctly written to and read from all areas of D-RAM (SDRAM). If an error occurs making this check, the test is aborted, with an error appearing on the touch panel (LCD).
Test pattern
Grid HT All-black output ---(For R&D) ---(For R&D) 4dot-6space (vertical) dot-6space (horizontal) ---(For R&D) 16 gray levels (monochromatic)
T-8-60
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-47
8
Procedure
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-48
Numeric keypad key 1 The input key and relay are shown below:
[1] [2]
1) Enter the PG number with numeric keys, then press the START key. 2) Select single-sided (SGL: 0) or double-sided (DBL: 1), then press the START key. 3) Enter the number of prints to be output (PG COUNT), then press the START key. 4) Specify the paper drawer (main unit), then press the START key. Main unit cassette (ST_C: 0), 2nd cassette (OP_C: 1), Manual feed tray (MLT: 2) 5) Specify the paper eject slot, then press the START key. Tray 1 (1_OUT: 0), Tray2 (2_OUT: 1) 6) Select a paper type, then press the OK key. Plain paper (PLN: 0), Thick paper (TCK: 1),Thin paper (OHP: 2) 7) A test pattern is output.
RELAY TEST1 OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF [3] [4] [5] [6] [3] S 2 [4] H 3 [5] D 4 [6] R 5
F-8-14
RELAY TEST2 OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF [3] [4] [5] [6] [7]
Description
Use it to turn on/off a selected relay to execute a switchover test. Frequency test The modem sends tonal signals from the modular jack and the speaker. G3 signal transmission test The modem sends G3 signals from the modular jack and the speaker. DTMF signal reception test Use it to generate the DTMF signal coming from the modem using the telephone line terminal and the speaker. Tonal signal reception test Use it to monitor a specific frequency and the DTMF signal received from the telephone line terminal by causing them to be indicated on the LCD (i.e., the presence/absence as detected). The reception signal is generated by the speaker. V.34 G3 signal transmission test The modem sends V.34 G3 signals from the modular jack and the speaker.
T-8-61
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] Relay CITS2 C1 NORG DCSEL DCLIM IPSEL1 IPSEL2 Keypad 0 1 2 3 4 5 6
F-8-15
CAUTION: The touch panel (LCD) is turned on or off in relation to the transmission of the relay operation signal as is operated on the keypad; for this reason, you cannot use the touch panel (LCD) to check a fault on a single relay.
Relay Test Press '1'or '2' on the keypad on the Modem test menu to select relay test mode. Use the keypad to operate the various relays of the NCU. '2' on the keypad is used for 230V machine.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-48
8
Frequency Test
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-49
A press on '2' on the keypad from the MODEM test menu selects the frequency test. In this test, signals of the following frequencies from the modem are transmitted using the telephone line terminal and the speaker. To select a different frequency, Keypad
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
MEMO: The output level of individual signals is in keeping with the setting made in service mode.
Frequency
462Hz 1100Hz 1300Hz 1500Hz 1650Hz 1850Hz 2100Hz
Tonal/DTMF Signal Reception Test A press on '6' on the keypad from the MODEM test menu selects the tonal signal/DTMF signal reception 0 test. In this signal, the tonal signal/DTMF signal received from the telephone line terminal can be checked to find out if it was detected by the modem.
Tonal signal reception test
T-8-62
MEMO: The frequency and the output level of individual frequencies are in keeping with the output level set in service mode.
G3 Signal Transmission Test A press on '4' on the keypad from the MODEM test menu selects the G3 signal transmission test. In this test, the following G3 signals from the modem are transmitted using the telephone line terminal and the speaker. To select a different transmission speed, use the keypad. Keypad
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
changes from '0' to '1' in response to detection of a signal of 46225Hz. changes from '0' to '1' in response to detection of a signal of 110030Hz. changes from '0' to '1' in response to detection of a signal of 210025Hz. DTMF signal reception test MODEM TEST OFF OFF OFF 5 The received DTMF signals are indicated starting from the right using the 2nd character of the display.
F-8-16
Transmission speed
300bps 2400bps 4800bps 7200bps 9600bps TC7200bps TC9600bps 12000bps 14400bps
V.34 G3 Signal Transmission Test A press on '8' on the keypad from the MODEM test menu selectes the V.34 G3 signal transmission test. The V.34 G3 signals below are sent from the modem using the modular
T-8-63
jack and the speaker by pressing the start key. The Baud rate can be changed with the keypad, and the Speed can be changed with the left/right arrow key. Keypad
0 1 2 3 4 5
MEMO: The output level of individual signals is in keeping with the setting made in service mode.
Baud rate
3429baud 3200baud 3000baud 2800baud 2743baud 2400baud
T-8-64
A press on '5' on the MODEM test menu selects the DTMF signal transmission test. In the test, the following DTMF signals from the modem are transmitted using the telephone line terminal and the speaker. The number pressed on the keypad selects a specific DTMF signal.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-49
8
Left/right arrow key Transmission speed
< > 2400bps 4800bps 7200bps 9600bps 12000bps 14400bps 16800bps 19200bps 21600bps 24000bps 26400bps 28800bps 31200bps 33600bps
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-50
Sensor test (6-2: SENSOR) This mode is used to verify the status of the unit sensors from the touch panel (LCD) indications. Press numeric keypad key 3 on the FUNCTION TEST menu to select the sensor test. To select a minor item, press the START key. The touch panel (LCD) indications change as the associated sensors turn on and off. Group Item Description Detail
0/Full, 1/Available 1/Cover open, 0/Cover closed (2) SENS/SW CHECK FLAG Sensor check CT: Waste Toner Full with flag Sensor(S17) (manual check) TC: Toner Cover Open/Closed Sensor (S16) MW: Manual Feeder Paper Size Sensor (S8) DO: Front Cover Open/Closed Sensor (S18) F1: No.1 Delivery Full Sensor (S11) F2: No. 2 Delivery Full Sensor (S41) CST Cassette check S: Cassette 1 Pickup Sensor (S1) SU: Cassette 1 Paper Sensor (S2) PE: Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor A (S3) ZA: Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor B(S4) S1: Cassette Size Detection Switch 1 (Width) (SW6) S2: Cassette Size Detection Switch 2 (Length) (SW7)
T-8-65
Type
G3 signal transmission test Sensor test Accessory ADF test Not used Not used Not used Not used Line signal reception test
Description
Transmits 4800-bps G3 signals to a telephone line and speaker Sensor actuation test ADF operation test
0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc
G3 signal transmission test (6-1: G3 480 bps Tx) Press numeric keypad key 1 on the FUNCTION TEST menu to select the G3 signal transmission test. This test transmits 4800-bps G3 signals from the telephone line connection terminal and speaker.
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-50
8
Group Item
READER
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-51
Description Detail
0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc MP: Manual Feeder Paper Sensor (S9) RE: Pre-Registration Sensor (S5) RP: Loop Sensor (S6) FX: Fixing Outlet Sensor (S19) D1/2:No.1 Delivery Sensor(S12)/No. 2 Delivery Sensor(S42) TU: Reversal Sensor (S40) DL: Duplex Feed Sensor (S7) W1: Document width sensor 1 W2: Document width sensor 2 L1: Document length sensor 1 L2: Document length sensor 2 LT: Last document detection sensor EX: Delivery reversal sensor DR: Read sensor
Description
Reader sensor C0: Copyboard Cover check Open/Closed Sensor 0 (S21) C1: Copyboard Cover Open/Closed Sensor 11 (S26) HP: iR2545/2535: CCD Hp Sensor (S22) iR2530/2525/2520: CIS Hp Sensor (S31) SIZE: Document size: Paper size indicated in a mix of document size sensors Document size sensor 0/1/2/3 Analog/digital HOP: Developing unit computation toner sensor (TS1) output sensor output value DEV: Sub hopper toner sensor (TS2) output value TEP: Temperature output value HUM: Humidity output value MTH: Fixing main thermistor (TH3) output value STH1: Fixing sub Thermistor (rear) (TH1) output value STH2: Fixing sub thermistor (front) (TH2) output value
Detail
0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 1/HP, 0/besides HP
Group
Item
COPY Copy confirmation sensor
ADF
A/D
0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc RG: Registration 0/Document presence, 1/Document paper sensor absenc CV: Cover open/close 1/Cover open, 0/Cover closed sensor DS: Document set 0/Document presence, 1/Document snsor absenc RK: Release motor 1/HP, 0/besides HP HP sensor TM: Timing sensor 0/Document presence, 1/Document absenc
T-8-67
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-51
8
Card reader test <6-3: NCR sts>
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-52
display changes from OFF to ON, indicating the received frequency. The touch panel (LCD) displays the status of CML, CNG and FED detection, from left to right, with ON/OFF indications. Numeric keypad key 2 turns on the CML relay to detect CNG. Test menu 3 Press numeric keypad key 3 on the LINE DETECT menu to select test menu 3. When the CNG signal is detected on the telephone line connection terminal, the touch panel (LCD) display changes from OFF to ON, indicating the received frequency. The touch panel (LCD) displays the status of CML, CNG and FED detection, from left to right, with ON/OFF
[4] Can status OK: Normal scan ERR: Scan error NG: Nonstandard error (No indication): No card [5] Equipment status IN: Initialization in progress RDY: Ready [6] Card reader version indication Four-digit number
Press numeric keypad key 3 on the FACULTY menu to select the card reader test. In this test, verify the successful operations of the card reader.
[1]
NCR Sts12345678 DPT MGN OK RDY 1234 [2] [3] [4] [5] [6]
[1] Card reader and card availability indication Card available: Eight-digit card ID No card: Card None No card reader available: NCR None [2] Card type and card reader status indication DPT: Department card PRC: Unit pricing card MAX: Upper limit setting card ERS: Erased card SRV: Service card (No indication): No card [3] Card type MGN: Magnetic card OPT: Optical card
indications. Numeric keypad key 3 turns off the CML relay to detect CNG.
F-8-17
Line signal reception test <6-9: LINE DETECT> Press numeric keypad key 9 on the FACULTY menu to select the line signal reception test. In this test, verify the successful operations of the NCU signal sensor and the frequency counter. Menu 1 detects the CI state, while menu 3 detects the CNG signal. Test menu 1 Press numeric keypad key 1 on the LINE DETECT menu to select test menu 1. When CI is detected on the telephone line connection terminal, the touch panel (LCD) display changes from OFF to ON, indicating the received frequency. The touch panel (LCD) also displays the on-hook or off-hook state of an external telephone set as detected. The touch panel (LCD) displays, from left to right, CI, CI frequency, hook port and FC with indications of 1:ON and 0:OFF. Test menu 2 Press numeric keypad key 2 on the LINE DETECT menu to select test menu 2. When the CNG signal is detected on the telephone line connection terminal, the touch panel (LCD)
Service Mode > Details of Service Mode > #TEST MODE > Details
8-52
Installation
How to check this Installation Procedure Making Pre-Checks Points to Make Before Installation Option Installation Sequence Checking the Contents Unpacking and Installation Procedure Document Tray-J1 Card Reader Serial Interface Kit-J2 Control Interface
9
Installation
Cable-A1 System Upgrade RAM-C1 System Upgrade SD CARD-A1 Cst Heater Kit-J1 Reader Heater Unit-H1 Cassette Heater Unit 37 Drum Heater-C1 Relocating the Machine
9
How to check this Installation Procedure
9-2
Making Pre-Checks
Selecting the Site of Installation
The followings are the condition for installation environment. It is better to see the planned location of installation before carrying the host machine in the user site. 1) The host machine can singly connect to the outlet of rated +/-10V, 15A or more.
F-9-1
2) The installation site must be in the following environment. Especially, avoid installing the machine near the faucet, water boiler, humidifier, or refrigerator. Operating environment:Temperature: 10.0 to 30.0oC Humidity: 20 to 80% 3) Avoid installing the machine near fire, in an area subject to dust or ammonia gas. When installing the machine in a place exposed to direct rays of the sun, it is recommended that curtains be hung over the windows. 4) The amount of ozone generated during use of the machine is below the harmful level. However, if the machine is used for a long time in a poor-ventilated room, ozone may smell. To keep the work environment comfortable, the room must be well-ventilated properly.
Tighten Claw
Remove
Connect
Disconnect
Secure
Free
5) None of the machine feet should float. The machine must be held level constantly. 6) The machine must be installed at least 10 cm away from the surrounding walls and there must be an adequate space for operating the machine.
Insert
Remove
Push
Plug in
Turn on
Checking instruction
Check
Visual Check
Sound Check
F-9-2
9-2
9
The width of the machine without an inner finisher is 1,079 mm.
100mm or more
9-3
500mm or more
hours before installing it. (Dew condensation: When a metallic object is brought from a low-temperature place to a high-temperature place, water vapor around it is cooled abruptly and consequently water drops stick to the surface of the metallic object.) 2) The maximum weight of the machine is approx. 78.8 kg (double-cassette model supplied with a DADF). Accordingly, two or more persons are required to lift the machine. Be sure to keep the machine in a horizontal position when lifting it. 3) This product was designed considering the potential connection to the Norwegian IT power distribution system.
500mm or more
565mm 1372mm
F-9-3
7) Install the machine in a well-ventilated place. Do not install the machine close to the ventilation duct of the room.
9-3
9
Checking the Contents
9-4
[1] Toner bottle x 1 (excluding the models for EU,US, LA, HK, and SP)
[3] Subtray x 1
[4] Reverse tray x 1 (only for the model with a 2 way unit)
[8] Cassette size label x 1 (for the model with one 550-sheet cassette) or x 2 (for the model with two 550-sheet cassettes)
[9] Cassette size plate (for 250-sheet cassette) x 1 (only for the model with 250-sheet cassette 1)
[10]Cassette size label (for 250-sheet cassette)x 1 (only for the model with 250-sheet cassette 1)
[12]Copy inhibition label For the model for US x 3 For the model for EU x 4 For the model for AU, LA, HK, and SP x1
9-4
9
[16] Glass cleaning/lamp caution label x 1 (for AU and EU supplied with an ADF <A type>) [17] Glass cleaning/lamp caution label x 1 (for AU and EU supplied with an ADF <AB/INCH type>)
9-5
[19] Finger pinch caution label 1 x 1 (only for the model for EU with an ADF) [20] Finger pinch caution label 1:x 1 (only for the model for US with an ADF)
[18] Document size label x 1 (only for iR2530/2525/2520 supplied with an ADF)
[21] Finger pinch caution label 2 x 1 (only for the model for EU with an ADF)
[22]Finger pinch caution label 2 x 1 (only for the model for US with an ADF)
T-9-1
T-9-2
Check to make sure that none of the following documentations and CDs is missing: Handy Operation Guide
Users Guide
Driver/Utility CD-ROM unit Users Manual CD-ROM Drum Warranty Card (only for the model for US) Registration Card (only for the model for US) Drum Replacement Procedure (only for the model for EU)
9-5
9
Unpacking and Installation Procedure
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Unpacking the Machine and Removing the Packaging Materials
9-6
MEMO: When installing a cassette pedestal, be sure to place the machine on the cassette pedestal. (For the procedure for installing the cassette pedestal, refer to the Cassette Pedestal Installation Procedure.)
1) Unpack the machine and remove the vinyl cover. 2) While holding four handles on the left and right sides of the machine, lift the machine to take it down from the palette.
CAUTION: The maximum weight of the machine is approx. 78.8 kg (double-cassette model with a DADF). Two or more persons are required to lift the machine.
F-9-4
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Unpacking the Machine and Removing the Packaging Materials
9-6
9
3) Remove all pieces of fixing tapes and materials. 4) For the iR2545/2535 Series, remove two optical system fixing screws on the right side of the reader. (Keep the removed screws because they may be used later for machine relocation.)
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Unpacking the Machine and Removing the Packaging Materials
9-7
5) Press the cassette release button to draw out the cassette forward. 6) Remove the wire that secures the intermediate plate of the cassette. <550 sheets cassette> <250 sheets cassette>
x2
F-9-5
F-9-6
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Unpacking the Machine and Removing the Packaging Materials
9-7
9
Installing the Toner Bottle
1) Open the toner supply cover.
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing the Toner Bottle
9-8
3) Unpack the new toner bottle, and then remove the cap.
F-9-7
F-9-8
F-9-9
MEMO: Turn the lock lever until it becomes level. If the lock lever is stopped in the middle, toner cannot be supplied normally.
F-9-10
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing the Toner Bottle
9-8
9
Installing the Drum Unit
1) Open the front cover
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing the Drum Unit
9-9
2) Press the button on the right cover to open the right door.
CAUTION: To prevent the drum unit from being damaged, keep the right cover open at least 5 cm during the installation procedure.
F-9-11
F-9-12
3) Turn the lock lever as shown below to release the collected toner container. 4) Take out the collected toner container.
5) Remove one screw from the developer pressure lever. The screw does not exist in some machine versions by destination. 6) Turn the lever as shown below to release the drum unit.
7) Remove the drum cover. (Keep the drum cover because it may be used later for machine relocation.)
x1
F-9-13
F-9-14
F-9-15
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing the Drum Unit
9-9
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing the Drum Unit
9-10
8) Unpack the new drum unit, remove packaging materials, and then pull two orange rings to remove the protective cover.
9) While holding the drum unit at the handle and the position shown below, insert it into the body slowly until it stops.
CAUTION:
CAUTION: When inserting the drum unit, check that the drum unit fits precisely with the rail of the host machine.
F-9-16
Do not touch the drum surface while at work. Do not expose the drum surface to light for a long period of time.
F-9-17
10) Turn the lever as shown below to lock the drum unit. 11) Secure the developer pressure lever with the screw.
12) Place the collected toner container in the machine. 13) Lower the lock lever to lock the collected toner container.
14) Close the front cover. 15) Close the right cover.
x1
F-9-18 F-9-19
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing the Drum Unit
9-10
9
Connecting the cord
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Connecting the cord
9-11
1) Insert the connector of the supplied Power cord into the AC inlet.
MEMO: Install an optionally available document glass cover or the DADF on the machine. If the model is the one without the DADF, install a document cover glass. For how to install the DADF, refer to the DADF Installation Procedure.
F-9-20
2) Install the supplied power cord clamp with the supplied screw *. *: Besides AU model, use the TP screw (M3 x 6). For AU model, use the stepped screw. Insert the left leg of the power cord clamp into the machine frame.
3) Plug the supplied Power cord in the wall outlet. 4) Peel off the protective seal from the operation panel. 5) Turn on the main power switch.
CAUTION: The specified power must be supplied. (Rated voltage 10% at the rated current)
x1
F-9-21
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Connecting the cord
9-11
9
Stirring Toner
9-12
1) A country/region setting screen appears. Make choices according to the environment where the machine is used. 2) Press the following keys in sequence below to call up the service mode screen: > 2 key > 8 key> 3) Select SERVICE MODE> CLEAR> ENGINE> TNRINST> OK.
MEMO: About five minutes are required for toner agitation. The machine stops automatically when it finishes toner agitation process. Install trays, cassettes, and other parts until toner agitation is completed.
Installing Trays
1) Install the supplied subtray. 2) Install the supplied reverse tray.
F-9-22
F-9-23
9-12
9
Setting the Cassettes
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Setting the Cassettes
9-13
1) Press the cassette release button to draw out the cassette forward. 2) Confirm the type of paper used by the customer. 3) While nipping the trailing edge guide lever, slide the trailing edge guide to the position corresponding to the prescribed paper size. 4) While nipping the side guide lever, slide the side guide to the position corresponding to the prescribed paper size. <550 sheets cassette> Side Guide Plate Side Guide Plate Lever <250 sheets cassette> Trail Edge Guide Plate Lever Side Guide Plate Side Guide Plate Lever
5-a) 500-sheet cassette: Set the supplied paper size label as shown below so that the size of the paper loaded 5-b) 250-sheet cassette: Affix the cassette size label corresponding to the size of the paper to in the cassette is shown below. be loaded in the cassette to the cassette size plate. Insert the cassette size plate into the cassette as shown. <550 sheets cassette> <250 sheets cassette>
A4
F-9-25 F-9-26
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Setting the Cassettes
9-13
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing Other Parts
9-14
6) Load paper in the cassette, and then push in the cassette. 7) For the double-cassette (standard) model, load paper in the other 550-sheet cassette and push in the cassette in the same manner as for the first cassette. 8) When a cassette pedestal is used, set up the cassettes with reference to the Cassette Pedestal Installation Procedure.
F-9-27
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing Other Parts
9-14
9
b.Affixing the ADF Label (only for the standard model with an ADF)
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing Other Parts
9-15
1) If the following labels are supplied, go through the steps described below. Document size label Finger pinch caution label 1 Finger pinch caution label 2
2) Align the side guide (rear) with the A4/A3 mark. A4/A3
F-9-28
3) Affix the document size label [A] of the suitable paper size series to the feeder cover in such a manner that the marks on the side guide (front) are aligned with the corresponding marks on the document size label when viewed by the user.
/A A4
TR 3 A
/11
x17
F-9-29
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing Other Parts
9-15
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing Other Parts
9-16
4) Affix the supplied finger pinch caution label 1 written in an appropriate language.
5) Open the DADF. 6) Affix the supplied finger pinch caution label 2 written in an appropriate language.
F-9-30 F-9-31
1) If the following labels are 2) Open the pressure plate/DADF. supplied, go through the 3) Affix the copy inhibition label [A] (written in an appropriate language) to the existing label. steps described below. 4) Affix the glass cleaning/lamp caution label or lamp caution label [B] written in an appropriate language to the existing label. (The label written in English is factory-affixed.) Copy inhibition label Glass cleaning/ lamp caution label [A] Lamp caution label [B]
F-9-32
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Installing Other Parts
9-16
9
Checking the Print Image
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Setting the Cassette Heater (if equipped with the cassette heater)
9-17
1) Place a document on the document glass, copy it by feeding paper from the cassette or manual-feed tray, and then check the resultant print image. Check that no abnormal noise is heard.
Check the image quality at respective magnifications. Check that the document is copied normally on the specified number of sheets.
ON
Setting the Cassette Heater (if equipped with the cassette heater)
1) On the customers request, turn the cassette heater ON according to the climate condition.
Installation > Unpacking and Installation Procedure > Setting the Cassette Heater (if equipped with the cassette heater)
9-17
9
Document Tray-J1 Installation Procedure
Points to Note before Installation
CAUTION
Installation > Document Tray-J1 Installation Procedure > Checking the Contents
9-18
When installing this equipment and USB Application 3-Port Interface Kit-A1 simultaneously, install the USB Application 3-Port Interface Kit-A1 first.
Installation > Document Tray-J1 Installation Procedure > Checking the Contents
9-18
9
Installation Procedure
In case of iR 2545/2535 Series
1) Remove the 2 Face Seals. (The removed Face Seals are no longer used.)
Installation > Document Tray-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of iR 2545/2535 Series
9-19
3) Hook the cut-off of the Document Tray (Reinforcing Plate) to the s p e sr w t h n d t e s a n D c m nTa-1nta n r c d r >nta n r c d r >n ae f 2 4 / 5 5 ees p ) t p d ce si t e nh I t l t > ou e t r yJ I s l t Poe ue I s l t Poe ue I c s oi 5 5 3 S r st 2. e g e i nao i ao i ao i R 2 i e
x2
Stepped Screw
Stepped Screw
Cut-off
F-9-34 F-9-35 F-9-36
Installation > Document Tray-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of iR 2545/2535 Series
9-19
9
In case of iR 2530/2525/2520 Series
1) Remove the 2 Face Seals. (The removed Face Seals are no longer used.)
Installation > Document Tray-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > When installing with USB Application 3-Port Interface Kit-A1 sim
9-20
2) Tighten the 2 stepped screws (RS tightening; M4X18) to the Reader Right Cover.
3) Hook the cut-off of the Document Tray (Reinforcing Plate) to the spesrwgeenesanDcmnry1san rcdr>san rcdr> hnsilgh SApo3 oecK1maeuye2 epdc shndhnai > ou eT - nai P eu nai P eu Wenaw Bpcin- nr e- i unossp) t e i t it I tlo t t taJI tlo o eI tlo o e i t tU ila Prta t s t l t . t t ni t If A l t i
x2
Stepped Screw
Stepped Screw
Cut-off
F-9-37 F-9-38 F-9-39
x2
F-9-40
Installation > Document Tray-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > When installing with USB Application 3-Port Interface Kit-A1 sim
9-20
9
Card Reader Installation Procedure
Checking the Contents
< Card Reader-E1 >
[1] [2] [3]
Installation > Card Reader Installation Procedure > Checking the Contents
9-21
[3]
Card reader TP screw (M3x12)) Toothed washer Repeating harness A Not used in this host machine.
F-9-43
Card reader mount Card reader cover Harness cover (base + lid) ) Repeating harness B Edge saddle TP screw (M4X16)
Binding screw (M4X6) Cord retainer Reuse band Repeating harness C Clamp TP screw (M4X6)
Not used in this host machine. Use only for iR2545/2535 Use for iR2530/2525/2520 or use for the installation of the Card Reader-E1 and the USB
Installation > Card Reader Installation Procedure > Checking the Contents
9-21
9
Points to Note Before Installation
Turning Main Power OFF
CAUTION Perform the following in the order prior to the installation. 1) Turn the main power of the host machine OFF.
9-22
2) Confirm the control panel display and the main power lamp have turned OFF and unplug the power cord.
Installation Procedure
a.Installing the card reader in a simple substance
1)Detach the rear cover (right). Screws (3 pcs.) Claws (2 pcs.) 2) Detach the rear cover (left). Screws (2 pcs.) Claws (2 pcs.)
x3 x2
Claws
x2 x2
Claws
F-9-44
F-9-45
9-22
9
3) Remove the screw from the card reader.
9-23
4) Remove the screw and the tooth washer securing the ground cable, and then separate the card reader from the card reader mount. The removed card reader mount is no longer necessary.
x1
CAUTION: When removing the harness through the opening in the card reader mount, take care not to cut or damage it.
x1
F-9-46
Card reader
F-9-47
5) Insert the card reader harness and ground cable into the hole in the supplied card reader mount. Using the screw removed in step 4), secure the card reader to the card reader mount.
6) Connect the ground cable [2] to the reader mount using the bundled binding screw (M4x6). 7) Attach the supplied edge saddle to the card reader mount.
x1
x1
Card reader
F-9-49
9-23
9-24
8) Connect the connector of the bundled repeating harness B to the connector on the card reader.
MEMO: Connect the repeating harness B's connector which is closer to the clamp to the connector of the card reader.
Clamp
9) Secure the repeating harness B clamp using the bundled binding screw (M4x6). 10) Disconnect the shorting connector. The removed shorting connector is no longer necessary.
x1
CAUTION: If the shorting connector is not disconnected, a malfunction or error can result.
x1 x1
F-9-50
F-9-51
12) Remove the two blind seals from the reader left cover. iR2545/2535 iR2530/2525/2520
x1
F-9-53 F-9-52
9-24
9
13) Attach the card reader to the reader. If iR2545/2535 series: bundled 2 TP screws (M4x6) If iR2535/2530/2525 series: bundled 2 TP screws (M4X16)
9-25
14) Slide the card reader cover to attach it to the card reader mount.
x2
F-9-54 F-9-55
15) Secure the card reader cover using the bundled binding screw (M4x6).
16) Affix the bundled harness cover (bases) at the right rear of the machine with it aligned with the bottom line of the reader as the figure below.
17) Attach the 2 bundled clamps at the position shown in the Figure.
x1
F-9-56 F-9-57
F-9-58
9-25
9-26
18) Connect the connector of the repeating harness B to the repeating harness C. Connect the connector without the protective tube of repeating harness C.
19) Connect the connector of the repeating harness C to the connector J8119 on the main controller PCB.
x1 x1
F-9-59
F-9-60
20) Secure the repeating harness C to the 8 clamps from the reader side, and route the repeating harness C shown in the Figure.
x8
Clamp
Core
F-9-61
9-26
9
21) Using the harness cover (lids), secure the repeating harness B to the harness covers (bases).
9-27
22) Using a nipper, remove the precut portion [1] of the rear cover (left) as shown below.
CAUTION: Finish the surface of the cut part of the cover to remove burrs.
F-9-63 F-9-62
23) Attach the rear cover (left) using the 2 screws. 24) Attach the rear cover (right) using the 3 screws.
CAUTION: Put the repeating harness in the cut portion of the rear cover (right).
F-9-64
9-27
9-28
b.Installing the Card Reader and the USB Application 3-Port Interface Kit-A1 at the same time
1) Install USB USB Application 3-Port Interface Kit-A1 earlier. 2) Remove the cable cover of USB Application 3-Port Interface Kit-A1. Claws (2 pcs.) 3) Perform steps 1) to 12) of "a. Installing the card reader in a simple substance ". 4) Attach the card reader to the reader using the 2 bundled TP screws (M4x16).
x2
Claw
x2
Claw
F-9-65
F-9-66
5) Perform steps 15) to 16) of " a. Installing the card reader in a simple substance ". 6) Route the cable to the USB cable guide.
7) Perform steps 18) to 21) and steps 23) to 25) of " a. Installing the card reader in a simple substance ". 8) Attach the cable cover of USB Application 3-Port Interface Kit-A1.
F-9-67
9-28
9
Registering the Card IDs
Installation > Card Reader Installation Procedure > Registering the Card IDs
9-29
After installing the Card Reader, register the card numbers to be used in the service mode of the host machine. If they are not registered, cards will not be recognized when inserted. 1) Plug the power cord into the outlet. 2) Turn on the main power switch. 3) When a message appears on the control panel display, press the following keys to enter the service mode: > 2 Key > 8 Key > 4) Get in Service Mode (# ACC> CARD) and enter the card number to use (1 to 2000). - Enter the smallest card number of the cards used by the user. - From the entered number, up to 1000 cards can be used. 5) Turn main power switch off and on again. 6) Insert the card with registered valid number to check it's at standby state.
Installation > Card Reader Installation Procedure > Registering the Card IDs
9-29
Installation > Serial Interface Kit-J2 Installation Procedure > Points to Note before Installation > Turning OFF the Host Machine
30
Installation > Serial Interface Kit-J2 Installation Procedure > Points to Note before Installation > Turning OFF the Host Machine
30
9
Installation Procedure
1) Remove the Power Supply Retainer and Power plug.
Installation > Serial Interface Kit-J2 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
31
1 Screw
3 Screws 2 Claws
x3 x2
Claws
F-9-68
F-9-69
3) Remove the SD Card Cover and the Left Rear Cover, and cut off the part of the Left Rear Cover indicated in the figure below with nippers.
4 Screws
CAUTION: When cutting off with nippers, be sure to cut it off fully.
x4
F-9-70
F-9-71
Installation > Serial Interface Kit-J2 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
31
9
4) Install the RS Conversion PCB on the RS232C Support Plate.
Installation > Serial Interface Kit-J2 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
32
3 Screws
x4
x3
F-9-72
F-9-73
6) Insert the CV-Serial Relay Cable included in the package to the 2 connectors on the PCB of the host machine.
7) Connect the RS Conversion PCB and the CV-Serial Relay Cable, and install the RS232C Support Plate by aligning the 2 Protrusions on the plate with the Holes on the host machin.
x2
x2
Protrusion Hole
Hole Protrusion
F-9-75
F-9-74
Installation > Serial Interface Kit-J2 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
32
Installation > Serial Interface Kit-J2 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
33
8) Be sure to put the harness [A] between the RS Conversion PCB and the plate [B] with the tie-wrap [C] of it on the front side.
[A]
[A]
9) Install the Controller plate. 10) Install the SD Card Cover. 11) Install the Rear Cover (Right). 12) Install the Power plug. 13) Install the Power Supply Retainer 14) Turn ON the main power switch.
[B]
[B]
[C]
F-9-76
Installation > Serial Interface Kit-J2 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
33
Installation > Control Interface Cable-A1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Turning Main Power OFF
9-34
[1]
Installation > Control Interface Cable-A1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Turning Main Power OFF
9-34
9
Installation Procedure
1) Remove the rear cover (right). Screws (3 pcs.) Claws (2 pcs.)
Installation > Control Interface Cable-A1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-35
2) Remove one screw and then the rear-left blanking cover. Screw (1 pc.)
x3 x2
Claws
F-9-77
F-9-78
x3
x3
F-9-79
F-9-80
Installation > Control Interface Cable-A1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-35
Installation > Control Interface Cable-A1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-36
5) To remove the core, cut the cable holder at the position shown below using nippers. 6) Cut the cable ties, and then remove the core of the control card cable.
F-9-81
7) Connect the connector of the control card cable to the connector on the image processor PCB as shown.
x1
x1
F-9-83 F-9-82
Installation > Control Interface Cable-A1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-36
9
9) Cut the blindfold cover from the rear-left cover using nippers.
Installation > Control Interface Cable-A1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-37
Rear-left blindfold cover Rear cover (right)
10) Install the controller cover. 11) Pass the control card cable in the opening made as mentioned above, and then install the rear-left cover.
F-9-84
CAUTION: Be sure to remove the remaining edges with care not to damage the harness.
F-9-85
Installation > Control Interface Cable-A1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-37
Installation > System Upgrade RAM-C1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Turning Main Power OFF
9-38
T-9-3
Installation > System Upgrade RAM-C1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Turning Main Power OFF
9-38
9
Installation Procedure
1) Remove the rear cover (right). Screws (3 pcs.) Claws (2 pcs.)
Installation > System Upgrade RAM-C1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-39
x3 x2
Claws
x3
F-9-86
F-9-87
3) Press the SW3 on the controller PCB and confirm LED10 has gone OFF. (This action is to cut the secondary power OFF.)
F-9-88
Installation > System Upgrade RAM-C1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-39
9
4) Release the 2 hooks to detach the 256MB RAM.
Installation > System Upgrade RAM-C1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-40
F-9-89
5) Insert the system upgrade memory in the slot where the 256MB RAM has been detached.
MEMO: Be sure the upgrade memory has firmly been inserted and the hooks are in the hole of the memory as shown.
F-9-90
Installation > System Upgrade RAM-C1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-40
Installation > System Upgrade RAM-C1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-41
6) Fix the controller plate with 3 screws (TP, M3x6). 9) Checking the Connection 7) Fix the rear cover (right) with 3 screws (RS-tight, M3x8). 8) Connect the power plug of the host machine to the power outlet and 9-1) Have the service mode display by pressing the following keys in order: turn its main power switch ON. >2key>8key> In response, [#SSSW] appears. 9-2) Use left or right cursor [< / >] key and press [OK] when [REPORT] has appeared. 9-3) Use left or right cursor [< / >] key and press [OK] when [REPORT OUTPUT] has appeared. 9-4) Use left or right cursor [< / >] key and press [OK] when [SPEC LIST] has appeared. 9-5) SPEC REPORT is printed out. Confirm TOTAL MEMORY is [512MB] on the report.
Installation > System Upgrade RAM-C1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-41
Installation > System Upgrade SD CARD-A1Installation Procedure > Points to Note before Installation > Turning OFF the Host Machine
9-42
Be sure that the eAM_License has been registered. Otherwise, the AM button may not be displayed on UI screen, and System does not become effective.
Installation > System Upgrade SD CARD-A1Installation Procedure > Points to Note before Installation > Turning OFF the Host Machine
9-42
9
Installation Procedure
1) Remove the SD Cover.
Installation > System Upgrade SD CARD-A1Installation Procedure > Checking after Installation
9-43
1 Screw
F-9-91
F-9-92
T-9-4
MEMO: If the AM button is displayed, it means that eAM has been recognized. If there is operation failure with the System Upgrade SD Card, E602 will be displayed.
Installation > System Upgrade SD CARD-A1Installation Procedure > Checking after Installation
9-43
9
Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure
Checking the Contents
[1] [2] [3]
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Turning Main Power OFF
9-44
[4]
[5]
[6]
[7]
F-9-93
Unpack the shipping carton and confirm the following components are contained in the carton.
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5]*1 [6]*1 [7] Heater PCB Heater SW harness Heater AC harness Heater DC harness High temperature caution label Cassette heater sheet Screw (RS-tight, M3x8) 1pc. 1pc. 1pc. 1pc. 1pc. 1pc. 1pc.
*1:These items are used only when the cassette heater is to be installed in the iR2530/2525/2520 series model with its 1st cassette capacity is 250 sheets. Save them even if the cassette heater is not being installed.
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Turning Main Power OFF
9-44
9
Installation Procedure
1) Remove the rear cover (right). Screws (3 pcs.) Claws (2 pcs.)
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-45
2) Cut off the blindfold cover of the rear cover (right) by a side cutter as shown.
x3 x2
Claws
CAUTION:
F-9-94
F-9-95
Finish the surface of the cut part of the rear cover (right) to remove burrs.
x3
F-9-96 F-9-97
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-45
9
5) Remove the connector cover. Screw (1 pc.)
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-46
x1
x1 x1
F-9-98
Claw
F-9-99
7) Remove the left cover and distort it to detach the inner bottom cover. Screw (1 pc.)
x1
F-9-100
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-46
9
8) Remove the left cover. Screw (1 pc.)
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-47
MEMO: When reinstalling the left cover, surely insert the link rod in the switch on the power supply unit so the switch does link to the main power switch of the host machine.
x1 x1
Link Rod
x2
F-9-101
CAUTION: There is the link rod behind the left cover, which is engaged to the switch on the power supply unit. So carefully remove the left cover not to give an excessive lord on the link rod.
F-9-102
MEMO: IInstall the heater SW harness in the correct direction referring to the figure in the power cord bracket.
F-9-103
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-47
9
10) Put the longer harness out of two through the hole of the rear frame.
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-48
11) Joint the connector of the longer harness of the heater SW harness to J108 of the power supply unit.
x1
F-9-104 F-9-105
x1
F-9-106
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-48
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-49
13) Unlock the wire saddles and stretch the folded harness as shown. Then joint the connector to the heater PCB.
x2
x1
F-9-107
14) Joint the connector of the heater DC harness, which is closer to the protective tube of the harness to J1102 of the heater PCB. 15) Clamp the 3 harnesses as shown in the figure.
x1
CAUTION: Scatter the slack of the wire and comfirm which the do not touch the part of the primary circuit.
F-9-108
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-49
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-50
16) Clamp the harness in the 4 wire saddles. 17) Joint the connector of the heater DC harness to J113B on the power supply unit.
x4
CAUTION: Scatter the slack of the wire and comfirm which the do not touch the part of the primary circuit.
F-9-109
18) Install the heater AC harness as shown in the figure. Joint the connector of the longest branch of the heater AC harness to the cassette junction bracket.
F-9-110
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-50
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-51
20) Restore the removed parts: Left cover (1 screw) Inner bottom cover (1 screw) Rear lower cover (1 screw) Connector cover (1 screw) Left rear cover (3 screws) Left rear blindfold cover (1 screw) Rear cover (right) (3 screws)
19) In case the cassette heater is not installed, disconnect the connector of the heater AC harness from the heater PCB and clamp it as shown in the figure.
x1 x1
x1
F-9-111
Installation > Cst Heater Kit-J1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure
9-51
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Confirmation of Heater Driver PCB
9-52
[3]
F-9-112
<For 230V model> Confirm the following components with correct quantities are contained in the carton.
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] Reader heater Heater harness Wire saddle (large) Wire saddle (small) Screw 2pcs. 1pc. 3pcs. 3pcs. 2pcs. (FK2-0228) (FM4-2929) (WT2-5719) (WT2-0507, only for use in iR-2545/2535) (XB2-8400-609)
<For 120V model> Get the following service parts ready for installation.
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] Reader heater Heater harness Wire saddle (large) Wire saddle (small) Screw 2pcs. 1pc. 3pcs. 3pcs. 2pcs. (FK2-9468) (FM4-2929) (WT2-5719) (WT2-0507, only for use in iR-2545/2535) (XB2-8400-609)
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Confirmation of Heater Driver PCB
9-52
9
Installation Procedure
Installation of Reader Harness
1)Detach the rear cover (right). Screws (3 pcs.) Claws (2 pcs.)
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Harness
9-53
x3 x2
Claws
x2
Claws
x2
F-9-113
F-9-114
x3
F-9-115
F-9-116
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Harness
9-53
9
5) Detach the connector cover. Screw (1 pc.)
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Harness
9-54
x1
x1 x1
F-9-117
Claw
F-9-118
7) Install the 3 supplied wire saddle (large) in the frame at rear left side.
F-9-119
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Harness
9-54
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Harness
9-55
8)Joint 1 connector of the heater harness to J1105 of the heater driver PCB. 9)Put 2 connectors through each hole as shown in the figure and set the heater harness in the wire saddles.
x9 x2
J1105
F-9-120
[A]
[B]
[C]
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Harness
9-55
9
Removal of Parts from Reader
1)Open the ADF (or platen Cover). 2)Remove 2 screws to detach the glass retainer (right). 3)Remove the platen glass.
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Heater (for iR2530/2525/2520 series)
9-56
x2
F-9-124
x1 x1
x1
F-9-125
F-9-126
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Heater (for iR2530/2525/2520 series)
9-56
9
4)Joint 1 connector and install the heater (right) with 1 screw.
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Heater (for iR2545/2535 series)
9-57
5)Restore the following parts: Platen glass Glass retainer (right) 2 screws 1 screw 1 screw 3 screws 1 screw 3 screws 2 screws
x1 x1
x1
Rear lower cover Connector cover Left rear cover Left rear blindfold cover Rear cover (left) Rear cover (right)
F-9-127
x1 x2 x1
F-9-129 F-9-128
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Heater (for iR2545/2535 series)
9-57
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Heater (for iR2545/2535 series)
9-58
4)Install the 1 supplied wire saddle (small), joint 1 connector and install the heater (right) with 1 screw. 5)Restore the following parts: Platen glass
x1 x1 x1
Glass retainer (right) Rear lower cover Connector cover Left rear cover Left rear blindfold cover Rear cover (left) Rear cover (right)
F-9-130
Installation > Reader Heater Unit-H1 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > Installation of Reader Heater (for iR2545/2535 series)
9-58
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Checking the Contents
9-59
Check that the Heater PCB-J1 is installed. If not, install the Heater PCB-J1 before installing the Cassette Heater Unit. The Cassette Heater Sheet and Warning High Temperature Label used for the 250-sheet Cassette Model is packed with the Heater PCB -J1.
F-9-131
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Checking the Contents
9-59
9
Turning OFF the Host Machine
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 550 Sheets Cassette Model
9-60
Turn OFF the main power switch on the host machine, and then remove the power plug from the outlet.
Installation Procedure
In case of 550 Sheets Cassette Model
1) Remove the cassette.
1 Screw 4 Connectors
1 Screw 1 Claw
Claw
F-9-132 F-9-133
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 550 Sheets Cassette Model
9-60
9
4) Install the wire saddle to Heater Connector Cover.
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 550 Sheets Cassette Model
9-61
5) Put the connector of the heater through the Wire Saddle and install the Heater Connector Cover.
F-9-134 F-9-135
MEMO: If a screw is on the bottom of the Cassette Base, remove the screw. (The removed screw will not be used.)
F-9-136
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 550 Sheets Cassette Model
9-61
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 550 Sheets Cassette Model
9-62
6) Install the Cassette Heater Unit by fitting the3 hooks to the holes .At that time, put the connector through the square hole. Cassette Heater Unit
F-9-137
7) Connect the Cassette Heater Unit with the stubby driver. 1 Screw (W sems round end; M3x6)
8) Connect the cassette heater connector to the heater relay cable connector.
9) Install the Lower rear cover 10) Connect the 4 Connectors. 11) Install the Connector Cover. 12) Install the removed Cassettes. 13) Check that the Environment Heater switch is ON. 14) Plug the power plug of the host machine to the outlet. 15) Turn ON the main power switch.
F-9-138
F-9-139
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 550 Sheets Cassette Model
9-62
9
In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
1) Remove the cassette. 2) Remove the Connector Cover.
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-63
2 Screws 4 Connectors
x2
x4
F-9-140 F-9-141
x3
Claw
x2
Claws
F-9-142
F-9-143
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-63
9
5) Remove the Heater PCB.
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-64
4 Connectors J1101 connector (SW side). J1102 connector (PSV side). J1103 connector (E controller side). J1106 connector
x4
F-9-144
1 Screw 1 Claw
Screw
Hole
6) Open the Front cover. 7) Open the Toner supply cover. 8) Open the Right cover. Claw
F-9-145
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-64
9
9) Remove the support cover.
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-65
2 Screws
x2
F-9-146
F-9-147
Boss
Boss
Hook Protrusion
F-9-148
Boss Hook
F-9-149
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-65
9
13) Install the Wire Saddle to Heater Connector Cover.
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-66
14) Affix the Cassette Heater Sheet on the cassette heater, and put the connector of the heater and install the heater connector cover through the Wire Saddle.
MEMO: If a screw is on the bottom of the Cassette Base, put a long screwdriver through the hole on the plate and remove the screw. (The removed screw will not be used.)
F-9-153
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-66
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-67
15) Install the Cassette Heater Unit by fitting the3 hooks to the holes .At that time, put the connector through the square hole. Cassette Heater Unit
F-9-154
16) After setting the cassette heater into the host machine, secure the heater in place with a long screwdriver by putting it through a hole on the plate. 1 Screw (W sems round end; M3x6)
F-9-155
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-67
9
17) Connect the connector at the heater side to the Heater Relay Harness.
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-68
18) Affix the Warning High Temperature Label to the specified area. (area between screw holes on the Base Plate)
CAUTION: Label Warning high temp label use a label corresponding to the language.
19) Install the Heater PCB. 20) Connect 4 connectors to the Heater PCB. 21) Install the removed covers. Lower rear cover Connector cover Delivery tray Inside base cover Screw on Left cover Right cover (upper) 22) Close the Right cover. 23) Close the Toner supply cover. 24) Close the Front cover. 25) Install the removed Cassettes. 26) Check that the Environment Heater switch is ON 27) Plug the power plug of the host machine to the outlet. 28) Turn ON the main power switch.
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 250 Sheets Cassette Model
9-68
9
In case of 1-Cassette Unit
1) Remove the cassette. 2) Remove the Connector Cover.
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 1-Cassette Unit
9-69
2 Screw 4 Connectors
x2
x4
F-9-158
F-9-159
3 Screw
x2
F-9-160
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 1-Cassette Unit
9-69
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 1-Cassette Unit
9-70
4) If equipped with the heater connector plate at rear side of the Cassette Module, remove it. (The removed heater connector plate will not be used.)
1 Screw
MEMO: When performing this procedure, it is not necessary to remove the Host Machine. However, the figure shows the picture with out the Host Machine to show easily.
F-9-161
6) Put the connector of the heater through the Wire Saddle and install the Heater Connector Cover.
F-9-162 F-9-163
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 1-Cassette Unit
9-70
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 1-Cassette Unit
9-71
MEMO: If a screw is on the bottom of the Cassette Base, remove the screw. (The removed screw will not be used.)
F-9-164
7) Install the Cassette Heater Unit by fitting the3 hooks to the holes .At that time, put the connector through the square hole.
Cassette Heater Unit
F-9-165
F-9-166
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 1-Cassette Unit
9-71
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 1-Cassette Unit
9-72
9) AT the rear side of the Cassette Module, pull out the connector at the heater side and the connect the connecter.
MEMO: When performing this procedure, it is not necessary to remove the Host Machine. However, the figure shows the picture with out the Host Machine to show easily.
F-9-167
11) Put the cable of the heater through a hole of the plate.
2 Wire saddles
x2
F-9-168
F-9-169
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 1-Cassette Unit
9-72
9
13) Connect the connector of the heater to the 1-Cassette Pickup Unit.
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 2-Cassette Unit
9-73
Connect the 4 Connectors. Install the Connector Cover. Install the removed Cassettes. Check that the Environment Heater switch is ON. Plug the power plug of the host machine to the outlet. Turn ON the main power switch.
F-9-170
1 Claw 2 Protrusions
Claw
MEMO: When performing this procedure, it is not necessary to remove the Host Machine. However, the figure shows the picture with out the Host Machine to show easily.
Protrusions
F-9-171
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 2-Cassette Unit
9-73
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 2-Cassette Unit
9-74
3) Fit the claws (3 places) on the Cassette Heater Unit into the holes on the Base Plate, and then move it toward the front.
3 Claws
CAIUTION: Be sure that the claws are fit into the holes of the Base Plate properly.
Base Plate
F-9-172
4) Tighten the removed screw (W sems round end;M3X6) with the stubby driver to connect the connector.
Connector
5) Install the heater Connector Cover. 6) Install the removed Cassettes. 7) Check that the Environment Heater switch is ON. 8) Plug the power plug of the host machine to the outlet. 9) Turn ON the main power switch.
F-9-173
Installation > Cassette Heater Unit 37 Installation Procedure > Installation Procedure > In case of 2-Cassette Unit
9-74
9
Drum Heater-C1 Installation Procedure
Checking the Contents
Installation > Drum Heater-C1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Turning Main Power OFF
9-75
Confirm the following components with correct quantities are contained in the carton.
[1]
[2]
F-9-174
Installation > Drum Heater-C1 Installation Procedure > Points to Note Before Installation > Turning Main Power OFF
9-75
9
Installation Procedure
1) Turn the main power OFF and unplug the power cord from the outlet. 2) Open the front cover.
9-76
CAUTION: To avoid any damage on the drum unit, keep the right cover open by 5 cm or more during installation.
F-9-176 F-9-175
4) Turn the lock lever as shown in the figureand remove the waste toner container.
5) Remove 1 screw from the developing pressure lever. The screw does not exist in some machine versions by destination. 6) Turn the developing pressure lever as shown in the figure and release the developing unit.
7) Slowly draw out the drum unit by half as shown while gripping the lever beneath the drum unit handle.
x1
F-9-177 F-9-178
F-9-179
9-76
9
8) Hold the drum unit as shown in the figure. Pull up the unit a little and draw it out completely.
9-77
9) Remove the 2 screws and release the claw to detach the toner replenish cover.
Claw
x2 x1
F-9-180
F-9-181
11) Dismount the harness from the developing stay and remove 2 screws to detach the developing stay. (Removed developing stay is no longer used.)
x1
x2
F-9-182 F-9-183
9-77
9
12) Remove the rear cover (right). Screws (3 pcs.) Claws (2 pcs.)
9-78
x3 x2
Claws
x1
F-9-184
F-9-185
14) Detach all the connectors at the place shown in the figure. (This is performed only when the optional cassette unit is installed.)
15) Remove 1 screw (RS tight: M3) and release 1 claw to detach the rear cover (lower). Screw (1 pc.) Claw (1 pc.)
x1 x1
F-9-186
Claw
F-9-187
9-78
9
16) Draw out the paper cassette(s). 17) Remove the left cover (lower). *For the model with the 1st cassette capacity is 550sheets: Screws (2 pcs.)
9-79
*For the model with the 1st cassette capacity is 250sheets: Screws (3 pcs.) Claw (1 pc.)
x2
x3
Claw
F-9-188 F-9-189
18) Remove 1 screw from the left cover and distort it to detach the inner bottom cover. Screw (1 pc.)
x1
F-9-190
9-79
9
19) Remove the left cover to detach it. Screw (1 pc.)
9-80
CAUTION: There is the link rod behind the left cover, which is engaged to the switch on the power supply unit. So carefully remove the left cover not to give an excessive lord on the link rod.
Link rod
x1
F-9-191
MEMO: When reinstalling the left cover, surely insert the link rod in the switch on the power supply unit so the switch does link to the main power switch of the host machine.
x1
x2
F-9-192
9-80
9
20) Remove 1 screw to detach the blindfold cover. Screw (1 pc.)
9-81
x3
F-9-193
F-9-194
22) Detach all the connectors on the power supply unit and remove 3 screws to dismount the power supply unit.
23) Mount 2 supplied wire saddles and 1 supplied edge saddle on the rear frame.
x3
F-9-196 F-9-195
9-81
9
24) Install the supplied drum heater unit in the host machine with 2 screws.
9-82
x2
F-9-197
MEMO: Insert the positioning pins of the drum heater unit to the holes of rear frame.
CAUTION: Do not damage the pre-transfer guide when installing the drum heater unit.
F-9-198
F-9-199
9-82
9
25) Fit the harness on the harness guide of the drum heater unit as shown.
9-83
26) Fix the drum heater harness in the 2 wire saddles and 1 edge saddle.
x3
F-9-200
F-9-201
27) Joint the connector of the drum heater harness to J1104 on the heater PCB.
x1
F-9-202
9-83
9-84
28) Restore the power supply unit with 3 screws and joint all the connectors for it. 29) Restore the toner replenish cover, the rear cover (right), the connector cover, the rear lower cover, the left lower cover, the left cover, the blindfold cover and the left rear cover. 30) Restore the inner bottom cover and fix 1 screw to the left cover.
x1
x3
F-9-203
31) Restore the developing unit and joint the developing unit connector. 32) Hold the drum unit handle and the part shown in the figure. Slowly draw it in till it stops.
33) Turn the developing pressure lever to set the developing unit and fix 1 screw. The screw is not necessary if it is not removed at the step 5).
CAUTION: Confirm engagement of the drum unit and the drum unit rail of the host machine.
x1
F-9-205
F-9-204
9-84
9
34) Restore the waste toner container.
9-85
35) Lock the waste toner container. 36) Close all the external covers.
F-9-206
F-9-207
9-85
9
Relocating the Machine
Required Articles
Have the following articles on hand: Fixing tape Drum cover removed during installation
9-86
2) For the iR2545/2535 Series, secure the optical system using the two screws removed during installation.
x2
Optical system fixing screws (2 pcs.) removed during installation (iR2545/2535 Series only)
3) Secure the front cover, toner supply cover, delivery section, and cassette with tape. 4) Place an A3-size sheet on the document glass, and then secure the document glass cover (ADF) with tape.
Work Procedure
1) Remove the drum unit, and then attach the drum cover removed during installation.
F-9-208
9-86
Appendix
Service Tools General Circuit Diagram
9
Service Tools
Special Tools
Tool name Digital multimeter Tool No.
FY9-2002
9-88
* A: each service engineer is expected to carry one. B: each group of 5 service engineers is expected to carry one. C: each workshop is expected to carry one.
Rank (*)
A
Shape
Uses
For making electrical checks.
Composition
fluoride-family hydrocarbon alcohol surface activating agent water
Remarks
Do not bring near fire. Procure locally. IPA (isopropyl alcohol) may be substituted.
FY9-3038
Lubricant
silicone oil
FY9-3039
T-9-6
FY9-9196
FL2-9842
--
Used for cleaning the mirror in the CCD unit. This part is installed in the reader unit. (Not a service tool)
T-9-5
9-88
9-89
J1
5 4 3 2 1
J2
1 2 3 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4
J0003
3 2 1
COR2
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
DDI_ITOP_OUT* IMG1L_IMAGE_END* L_GND IMG1L_TXD IMG1L_RXD L_GND DDI_LIVEWAKE* DDI_PI0 DDI_DOWNLOAD* IMG_SYS_RST* L_GND DDI_RESET* DDI_POWER* DDI_CPRDY* DDI_PPRDY* L_GND DDI_CTS* DDI_RTS* DDI_TXD DDI_RXD L_GND DDI_PPRTST* LASER_DETECT* HAND_SET* POLYGON_M_BD* L_GND
CSR
J208
L_GND
1 2
9 10 11 12 13 14
13 12 11 10
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
J8143
J8142
J8114
Soft-ID PCB
J9903
J8112
VH
6 5 4 3
J201
2 1
J8125
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
+24VR
+5VR
+5VR
+5VC
GND
GND
+3.3V
ESS1
GND
GND
GND
11 10
J103
VH
J104
J105
2 3
NO
FT5
1 2
FT6
+24VR
COR1 J108
1 2 3
P1
1 2 3
1 2 3
H N
J2000
J1101
J0001
9-89
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (550-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (1/7)
POLYGON_M_ACC*
POLYGON_M_DEC*
POLYGON_M_FG*
QVGA_LATCHP
QVGA_STARTP
QVGA_LCDEN
QVGA_XCLK*
UI_SOFTSW*
QVGA_UD0
QVGA_UD1
QVGA_UD2
DATA_C+
DATA_D+
CTRL0_2
CTRL0_1
CTRL0_0
DATA_C-
DATA_D-
QVGA_UD3
RESET_UI*
BKLTON
UI_RXD
UI_TXD
+3.3R
+3.3V
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
DETECT
DETECT
P_GND
+24R
+3.3V
PWM
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
+5V
BD
GND
+5R
+5R
J210
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
J8116 J8115
3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6
+24U_LOCK
P-GND
+24R
P-GND
+5R
L-GND
J508
1 2 3 4
COM
J106
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (550-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (1/7)
9-90
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (550-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (1/7)
9-90
9-91
Main Motor M1
M
6 6 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1
HVT PCB
J301 J2002
25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J2003
1 3
2 2
3 1
J1103
3 2
J2001
9 10 11 12 13
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
J202
J205
J203
J204
J206
2 1
21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
J2506
J2501
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
1 8
2 7
3 6
4 5
5 4
6 3
7 2
8 1
J2561
J2502
1 9
2 8
3 7
4 6
5 5
6 4
7 3
8 2
9 1 1 3 2 2 3 1
J2590
J2010
1 2 3
J2009
1 3 2 2 3 1 1 3 2 2 3 1
J2008
1 1 2 2 1 2
J2007
3 1 2
J2006
3 1 2
J2005
3
J2004
J2012
J2011
S6 Loop Sensor
3 2 1
3 2 1 2 1
S9
SL
S8
J2016
1 3
2 2
3 1
J2014 J2013
4 3 2 2 3 1 4
SL2
4 1
3 2
2 3
1 4
J2015
M7 Hopper Motor
M6 Bottle Motor
9-91
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (550-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (2/7)
P_POWER_ESS2
ENV_HEATER_PRINT*
PSU_FAN_LOCK*
CHRG_DC_CTRL
CHRG_AC_CTRL
PSU_DETECT1*
PSU_DETECT2*
CHRG_AC_DRV
RELAY_DRIVE*
DEV_DC_CTRL
HEATER1_ON*
HEATER2_ON*
DEV_AC_DRV*
CHRG_DC_ON
MAIN_M_DEC*
MAIN_M_ACC*
ZERO_CROSS
PSU_FAN_ON
TR_N_DC_ON
TR_CC_CTRL
DEV_AC_ON*
CHRG_I_SNS
MAIN_M_FG*
DEV_DC_ON
FIX_M_ACC*
FIX_M_DEC*
DOOR_MSW
DIS_DC_ON
+24U_LOCK
+24U_LOCK
+24U_LOCK
+24U_LOCK
+24U_LOCK
TR_P_DRV*
FIX_N_DRV
FIX_M_FG*
DIS_CTRL
FIX_CTRL
DC_CLK
HVT_ENB
TR_CHG
P-GND
P-GND
GND
GND
GND
N.C.
P-GND
L-GND
L-GND
+3.3R
N.C.
HOPPER_M_LOCK*
P-GND
HOPPER_M_ON
HOPPER_LEVEL_SNS
BOTTLE_M_LOCK*
P-GND
BOTTLE_M_ON
L-GND
+24R
DEVELOP_LEVEL_SNS
FREE
DUPLEX_SNS
LOOP_SNS
L-GND
+24R
WASTE_TONER_FULL_SNS
L_GND
+5R
TONER_COVER_SNS
L-GND
+5R
FAN_R_LOCK*
P-GND
FAN_R_ON
FAN_F_LOCK*
P-GND
FAN_F_ON
MP_SL_ON
+24R
MP_PAPER_SNS
L_GND
+5R
MP_WIDE_SNS
L_GND
+5R
L_GND
+5R
L_GND
+5R
1 2 3
9-92
Cassette Size Cassette Size Detection Switch 2 Detection Switch 1 Front Cover Open/Closed Sensor S18
3 3 2 2 1 1
Pre-Registration Sensor S5
3 2 1
Cassette 1 Cassette 1 Cassette 1 Paper Paper Level Paper Level Sensor Sensor B Sensor A S2
2 1 3
SW7
J2019
5 4 3 2 1 5
SW6
J2020
4 3 2 1
S4
2 1 3
S3
1 2 1 2 2 1
Developing Cylinder Manual Feed Duplex Feed Clutch Pickup Clutch Clutch CL3 CL2 CL4
CL
1 2 1
J2034
J2021
J2022
J2023
J2024
J2025
CL
2
CL
2 1
CL
2
J2018
1 2
2 1
1 2
2 1
1 2
2 1
1 2
2 1
J2027 J2545
1 3 2 2 3 1
J2028
J2029
J2432
J2532
1 10
2 9
3 8
4 7
5 6
6 5
7 4
8 3
9 10 2 1
6 9
7 8
8 7
9 10 11 12 13 14 6 5 4 3 2 1
14 13 12 11 10
J2533
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
9 10 11
MT21
J209
J211
CSR
J212
J213
2 1
MT20
J2033
1 1 2 2 3 3 1 1 2 2 3 3
J2032
1 2 2 1
J2433
SL
9-92
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (550-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (3/7)
PAPER_LEVEL_B_SNS
ENV_SNS_DETECT*
PAPER_LEVEL_A_SNS
CST_FEED_SL_ON
CST_PAPER_SNS
CST_MP_CL_ON
ENV_SNS_DATA
ENV_SNS_CLK
DOOR_SNS
CST_FEED_SNS
C_SIZE_W4
C_SIZE_W3
C_SIZE_W2
C_SIZE_W1
C_SIZE_L4
C_SIZE_L3
C_SIZE_L2
C_SIZE_L1
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
+3.3R
DUPLEX_CL_ON
SLEEVE_CL_ON
REGIST_SNS
REGIST_CL_ON
L-GND
+24R
+24R
+24R
+24R
N.C.
N.C.
+24R
+5R
+5R
+5R
+5R
+5R
+5R
A*
B*
N.C.
+24R
+5R
+5R
1EXIT_SL_ON
L-GND
L-GND
EXIT1_FULL_SNS
EXIT1_SNS
9-93
J703
+24R P-GND
J9915
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
to Cassette 2
J9907
1 2 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2
to Cassette 1
J9908
1
1 2
J701
2 1
J9909
1 2 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2
J9910
1
to Reader Heater
J9916
2 1
J9915
1 2
N.C.
FIN_DL_RESET
OP2_EX_SEND
OP1_EX_SEND
OP2_EX_LOAD
OP2_DETECT
OP1_EX_LOAD
+24VR2
9 10 11
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
J113A
1 2 3
J113B
J109
J226
J222
J223
9 10 11
J221
J224
J1105
COM
J214
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J220
19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
H2
H1
J2505
MT6
J1106
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 2 1
J2510 J9913
6 5 4 3 2 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
J2504
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
to 2 Way Unit
ET3
2 1
J2100
1
ET4 ET5
ET6
J2101
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
J2063
1 6 2 5 3 4 4 3 5 2 6 1
J9911
to Cassette Heater
1 1
2 2
3 3
J2046
S19 Fixing Sub Fixing Main Thermistor Thermistor Fixing Outlet Sensor
OP1_DETECT
OP2_M2_CLK
OP2_M1_CLK
OP1_M1_CLK
OP2_EX_CLK
OP2_READY
OP1_READY
FIN_MODE
FIN_RxD
FIN_TxD
RESET*
P-GND
P-GND
OP1_EX_CLK
FIN_ENABLE
RESET*
FIN_BIT
GND
GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
+24R
+24R
L-GND
ESS
+5R
+5R
N.C.
N.C.
TH_DETECT*
L-GND
SUB1_TH
L-GND
MAIN_TH
L-GND
FIX_OUT_SNS
L-GND
+5R
P-GND
P-GND
+24R
L-GND
+5R
L-GND
+3.3R
EXIT2_DETECT*
M_STANDBY*
REVERSE_M_I0
REVERSE_M_I1
REVERSE_M_CLK
REVERSE_M_CWCCW
EXIT2_SL_ON
REVERSE_SL_ON
EXIT2_SNS
EXIT2_FULL_SNS
REVERSE_SNS
L-GND
1 2 3
MT5
Fixing Heater 2
Fixing Heater 1
MT7
1
H2
H1
TP1 TP
2
MT8
MT4
MT2
TH2
2
TH1
2
9-93
9-94
J309
2
14 15 13
12 11
10 9
8 7
6 5
4 3
J308
2 1 4
J8151
3 2 1
Copyboard Cover Open/Closed Sensor (Front) Copyboard Cover Open/Closed Sensor (Rear)
S33
1 2 3
J575
1 2 3
3 2 4
5 6
7 8
9 10
11 12
13 14
15 16
17 18
19 20
21 22
23 24
25 26
27 28
29 30
31 32
33 34
1 2
3 4
5 6
7 8
9 10
11 12
13 14
15
CVR_SENS1 GND
6
J552
+3.3V
J554
J553
S32
1 2 3
J585
1 2 3
/B B A /A
J555
J579
J573
1 1 2 3 2
S34
1 1 2 3 P 2 S 3
J583
J563
S36
S 3 2 P 1 1
J587
3
S37
S 3 2 2 P 1 1
Original Size Sensor 2 (INCH/AB, AB/K, AB, INCH/A) Original Size Sensor 3 Original Size Sensor 2 (A)
+5V
J0563
S34
1 1 2 3 1 2 3 P 2
J0583
GND SIZE0
J577 J0557
3
S35
1 P 2 3 S
S36
S 3 2 2 P 1 1
J0573
J0587
J00563
J556
3 2 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3
J562
2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3
J561
2 1
J560
1 2 3 4 3
J564
2 1
J558
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ADF_COVER
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog) Vout3
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Frame)
J576
1 1 2 2 3 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 1 2 3
J582 (CN1)
J581 (CN2)
J580 (CN10)
J584 (CN12)
3 2 4
5 6
7 8
9 10
11 12
13 14
15 16
17 18
19 20
21 22
23 24
25 26
27 28
29 30
J588
CIS
GND(Frame)
ADF_SENS
HP_SENS
RMOT_IA
RMOT_IB
KMOT_IA
KMOT_IB
SIZE_W2
RMOT_A
RMOT_A
RMOT_B
RMOT_B
KMOT_A
KMOT_A
KMOT_B
KMOT_B
RK_ON1
SIZE_L1
STAMP
EMPTY
FANLOCK
SIZE_W1
SIZE_L2
FANON
LED_G1
LED_G2
LED_R1
+24V LED_B2
LED_B1
CLK(+)
MODE
CLK(-)
VREF
+3.3V
+3.3V
Vout2
Vout1
Vout0
SP(+)
+24V
SP(-)
LED_R2
+3.3R
+3.3V
LAST
+24V
EXIT
GND
GND
+24V
GND
GND
REG
DES
F-9-214
9-94
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (550-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (5/7)
SIZE_SENS_ON
COVER_SENS0
RTP1BPWM
RTP1APWM
HP_SENS
SIDATAO
KMOT_IA
*KMOT_A
*KMOT_B
KMOT_IB
KMOT_A
KMOT_B
SIDATAI
SVCLK+
SILOAD
SVCLK-
EMPTY
*HSYNCI
*VSYNC
*RESET
*RTP1B
*RTP1A
STAMP
DOUT7
DOUT6
DOUT5
DOUT4
DOUT3
DOUT2
DOUT1
RTP1B
RTP1A
DOUT0
SICLK
+3.3V
LAST
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
EXIT
GND
GND
GND
REG
DES
+5V
6 4
J559
1 2
3 1
2 1
J557
1 2
3 4
5 6
J505
1 2
4 5
9-95
J9999
1 2
J2 USB
USB(H)
J8103 USB A
MODEM PCB
1 2
FM4-3341 FM4-3342
J112
VOUT2 VOUT1
1 2
B_PRDY B_CRDY C_PRDY C_CRDY GND COIN_TX COIN_RX GND VCC(5Vor3.3V) GND
9 10 11
GND
to Coin Vendor
J8146
3 2 1 1 2
J8134
J8147
6 5 4 3 2 1 22
21 20
19 18
17 16
15 14
13 12
11 10
9 8
7 6
5 4
3 2
J8127
J8124
2 1
TX_OUT
SNOOP
HOOK1
CICNT_OUT
HOOK2
DCLIM
CAIDD
RX_IN
AGND
IPSEL
CMLD
LPRD
+12V
+3.3V
LPL1
LPL2
CIVS
GND
GND
GND
+24V
GND
GND
HRD
SRD
N.C.
PRD
N.C.
N.C.
+5V
+5V
CI1
CI2
J001
J002
J02
NCU PCB
VH(+) VH(-)
1 2
FAX BOX
F-9-215
J004
J4
Secondary Battery
J1
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
FFC
(+)
(-)
11
13
15
17
19
21
Modular PCB
J0002
GND
J9904
MODEM PCB
+5V
CCVI CP ENB
CCVI CL BW L
CCVI OPTION
GND
J9901
+5V
CARD_READER_COUNT
J8103
J8104
J8110
J8111
CARD_READER_TX
USB(H)
USB(D)
SDcard
LAN
J2571
CARD_READER_RX
1 2 3 4 5
Card Reader
+24V
GND
J8117
J8149
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2
J8118 J8140
J003
1 2 3
J3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
9-95
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (550-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (7/7)
Contorol Panel
Touch Panel
1
TTP-L
P-GND J1 K-DGT3 K-DGT4 K-DGT5 K-DGT6 K-DGT7 K-RTN1 K-RTN2 K-RTN3 K-RTN4 L-DGT3 L-DGT4 L-DGT5 L-RTN1 POWER-LED K-DGT0 K-DGT1 K-DGT2 K-RTN0 L-DGT0 L-DGT1 L-DGT2 L-RTN0 ESS-KEY VLCD -24VEE VLCG
TTP-D
3 4
TTP-R
TTP-U
1 2
J7 J6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
J5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
J3
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
SOLDER
16 17 18 19 20 21 22
9 8 7 6 5 4
J955
SOLDER
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (550-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (7/7)
J4
10
11
12
13
14
J1
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
23 24 25 26 27
3 2 1
LP
D0
D1
D2
D3
YD
+5R
1
+5R
N.C.
XSCL
VLCD
DOFF*
L-GND
-24VEE
-24VEE
BKLT_ON*
LCD
CCFL
2 3 4
F-9-216
9-96
9-96
9-97
J1
5 4 3 2 1
J2
1 2 3 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4
J0003
3 2 1
POLYGON_M_ACC*
POLYGON_M_DEC*
POLYGON_M_FG*
QVGA_LATCHP
QVGA_STARTP
QVGA_LCDEN
QVGA_XCLK*
UI_SOFTSW*
QVGA_UD0
QVGA_UD1
QVGA_UD2
DATA_C+
DATA_D+
CTRL0_2
CTRL0_1
CTRL0_0
DATA_C-
DATA_D-
DETECT
DETECT
+3.3V
QVGA_UD3
RESET_UI*
BKLTON
P_GND
UI_RXD
UI_TXD
+24R
+3.3R
+3.3V
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
PWM
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
+5V
J208
1 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
9 10 11 12 13 14
13 12 11 10
BD
L_GND DDI_ITOP_OUT* IMG1L_IMAGE_END* L_GND IMG1L_TXD IMG1L_RXD L_GND DDI_LIVEWAKE* DDI_PI0 DDI_DOWNLOAD* IMG_SYS_RST* L_GND DDI_RESET* DDI_POWER* DDI_CPRDY* DDI_PPRDY* L_GND DDI_CTS* DDI_RTS* DDI_TXD DDI_RXD L_GND DDI_PPRTST* LASER_DETECT* HAND_SET* POLYGON_M_BD* L_GND
J8143
J8142
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
J8114
GND
+5R
+5R
J9903 J0001
J8112
J201
J8125
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
+24VR
+3.3V
ESS1
GND
GND
GND
+5VR
+5VR
+5VC
GND
GND
11 10
J103 J551
J104
GND
J105
+24VR
J108
1 2 3
2 1 2 3 1 2 3 1
J2000
SOLD6
J1101
SOLD7
GND
SPD_DAT
SPD_CLK
FRAM_WP
GND
J210
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
GND
J8116
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6
Soft-ID PCB
+3.3V
+24U_LOCK
P-GND
P-GND
L-GND
+24R
+5R
J106
1 2 3 4
1 2 3
SOLD5 SOLD4
9-97
9-98
1 2 3
Fixing Motor M2
M
Main Motor M1
M
7 7 6 6 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1
HVT PCB
J2002 J301
25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J2003
1 3
2 2
3 1
to Heater PCB
3 2 1
J1103
J2001
5 5
4 4
3 3
2 2
1 1
ENV_HEATER_PRINT*
PSU_FAN_LOCK*
P_POWER_ESS2
CHRG_DC_CTRL
CHRG_AC_CTRL
PSU_DETECT1*
PSU_DETECT2*
CHRG_AC_DRV
RELAY_DRIVE*
DEV_DC_CTRL
DEV_AC_DRV*
HEATER1_ON*
HEATER2_ON*
MAIN_M_DEC*
MAIN_M_ACC*
CHRG_DC_ON
ZERO_CROSS
PSU_FAN_ON
DEV_AC_ON*
MAIN_M_FG*
FIX_M_ACC*
FIX_M_DEC*
TR_N_DC_ON
TR_CC_CTRL
CHRG_I_SNS
DEV_DC_ON
DOOR_MSW
DIS_DC_ON
+24U_LOCK
+24U_LOCK
+24U_LOCK
+24U_LOCK
1 1
FIX_M_FG*
GND
GND
GND
9 10 11 12 13
N.C.
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
J202
J205
J203
J204
J206
2
J2501
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2
21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
+24U_LOCK
FIX_N_DRV
TR_P_DRV
DIS_CTRL
FIX_CTRL
HVT_ENB
TR_CHG
DC_CLK
P-GND
P-GND
P-GND
L-GND
L-GND
+3.3R
FAN_R_LOCK*
P-GND
FAN_R_ON
FAN_F_LOCK*
P-GND
FAN_F_ON
MP_SL_ON
+24R
MP_PAPER_SNS
L_GND
+5R
MP_WIDE_SNS
L_GND
+5R
L_GND
+5R
LOOP_A_SNS
L_GND
+5R
FREE
DUPLEX_SNS
L-GND
+24R
WASTE_TONER_FULL_SNS
L_GND
+5R
TONER_COVER_SNS
L-GND
+5R
J2502
1 9
2 8
3 7
4 6
5 5
6 4
7 3
8 2
9 1 1 3 2 2 3 1
1 8
2 7
3 6
4 5
5 4
6 3
7 2
8 1
J2561
J2590
J2012
J2011
J2010
1 3
2 2
3 1
J2009
1 3
2 2
3 1
J2005
J2506
XR
1 3 2 2 3 1
N.C.
1 3
HOPPER_M_LOCK*
2 2
P-GND
3 1
HOPPER_M_ON
HOPPER_LEVEL_SNS
BOTTLE_M_LOCK*
P-GND
BOTTLE_M_ON
L-GND
+24R
DEVELOP_LEVEL_SNS
J2004
3 2 1
3 2 1
J2007
J2006
J2008
1 2
2 1
SL
4 1 2 1 4 3 2 1 2
J2013
J2015
S6 Loop Sensor
M7 Hopper Motor
M6 Bottle Motor
F-9-218
9-98
9-99
SW6
J2020
1 5 4 3 2 1
J2019
5 4 3 2
Pre-Registration Sensor S5
J2034
3 2 1
J2022
J2025
Developing Manual Feed Duplex Feed Cylinder Pickup Clutch Clutch Clutch CL3 CL2 CL4
CL
1 2 1
CL
2 1
CL
2
Enviorment Sensor
J2017
1 2 3 4
1 2
2 1
J2027
1 2
2 1
J2028
1 2
2 1
J2029
1 2
2 1
J2432
J2018
J2534
1 5
2 4
3 3
4 2
5 1
1 5
2 4
3 3
4 2
5 1
2 2
3 1
J2536
J2545
1 5
2 4
3 3
4 2
5 1
J2535
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
9 10 11
J209
J211
J212
J299
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J225
2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3
J213
2 1
J2033
J2032
1 2
2 1
J2433
SL
9-99
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (250-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (3/7)
ENV_SNS_DETECT*
CST_FEED_SL_ON
CST_PAPER_SNS
CST_MP_CL_ON
C_SIZE_W4
C_SIZE_W3
C_SIZE_W2
C_SIZE_W1
C_SIZE_L4
C_SIZE_L3
C_SIZE_L2
C_SIZE_L1
L-GND
L-GND
+24R
DUPLEX_CL_ON
ENV_SNS_DATA
SLEEVE_CL_ON
REGIST_CL_ON
ENV_SNS_CLK
REGIST_SNS
DOOR_SNS
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
+3.3R
+24R
+24R
+24R
+24R
N.C.
N.C.
N.C. +5R
+5R
+5R
+5R
EXIT1_FULL_SNS
EXIT1_SNS
L-GND
L-GND
+5R
9-100
J9914
J703
1 2
J9915
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J701
2 1
to Cassette 2
J9907
1 2 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2
to Cassette 1
J9908
1
J9909
1 2 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J9910
J9916
2 1
J9915
1 2
N.C. H
to Reader Heater
FIN_DL_RESET
OP2_EX_SEND
OP1_EX_SEND
OP2_EX_LOAD
OP2_DETECT
OP1_EX_LOAD
FIN_ENABLE
+24VR2
N
2 1 2 1 3 2 1
9 10 11
J113A
1 2 3
J1113B
J109
VH
J226
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
J222
J223
9 10 11
J221
J224
J1105
COM
H2
H1
J110
3 2 1
J214
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3
J220
2 1
J2505
MT6
J1106
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J2510
N.C. N.C. N.C.
6 5 4 3 2 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
J2504
to 2 Way Unit
J9913
ET3
2 1
J2100
1
J2101
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
1 6
2 5
3 4
4 3
5 2
6 1
J2063
J9911D
to Cassette Heater
J2046
S19 Fixing Sub Fixing Main Fixing Outlet Sensor Thermistor Thermistor
OP1_DETECT
OP2_M1_CLK
OP2_M2_CLK
OP1_M1_CLK
OP2_EX_CLK
+24S_ACC
OP1_EX_CLK
OP2_READY
OP1_READY
FIN_MODE
FIN_RxD
FIN_TxD
FIN_BIT
RESET*
RESET*
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
P-GND
P-GND
GND
GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
L-GND
ESS
+5R
+24R
N.C.
+5R
N.C.
N.C.
TH_DETECT*
L-GND
SUB1_TH
L-GND
MAIN_TH
L-GND
FIX_OUT_SNS
L-GND
+5R
P-GND
P-GND
+24R
L-GND
+5U_SNS
L-GND
+3.3R
EXIT2_DETECT*
M_STANDBY*
REVERSE_M_I0
REVERSE_M_I1
REVERSE_M_CLK
REVERSE_M_CWCCW
EXIT2_SL_ON
REVERSE_SL_ON
EXIT2_SNS
EXIT2_FULL_SNS
REVERSE_SNS
L-GND
1 2 3
MT5
Fixing Heater 2
Fixing Heater 1
MT7
1
H2
H1
TP1 TP
2
MT8
MT4
MT2
1 2
TH2
TH1
2
9-100
9-101
J308
2 1 4
J8151
3 2 1
S33 Copyboard Cover Open/Closed Sensor (Front) S32 Copyboard Cover Open/Closed Sensor (Rear) S35 Original Size Sensor 1 (INCH, AB/K, AB) S34 Original Size Sensor 0 (INCH, AB/K, AB)
J575
1 1 2 3
3 2 4
5 6
7 8
9 10
11 12
13 14
15 16
17 18
19 20
21 22
23 24
25 26
27 28
29 30
31 32
33 34
1 2
3 4
5 6
7 8
9 10
11 12
13 14
15
CVR_SENS1 GND
6
J552
+3.3V
J554
J553
J585
1 1 2 3
/B B A /A
J555
J579
J573
1 1 P 2 2 3
J583
J587
3
S36 Original Size Sensor 2 (INCH/AB, AB/K, AB, INCH/A) S37 Original Size Sensor 3 S36 Original Size Sensor 2 (A)
SR37
S34 Original Size Sensor 0 (INCH/A) S35 Original Size Sensor 1 (A)
J0583
J0563
J577 J0557
3
J0573
1 1 P 2 2
J0587
J00563
J556
3 2 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3
J562
2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3
J561
2 1
J560
1 2 3 4 3
J564
2 1
J558
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ADF_COVER
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog) Vout3
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Analog)
GND(Frame)
LED_G2
J576
1 1
2 2
3 3
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
9 10 11 12
J582 (CN1)
J581 (CN2)
J580 (CN10)
J584 (CN12)
3 2 4
5 6
7 8
9 10
11 12
13 14
15 16
17 18
19 20
21 22
23 24
25 26
27 28
LED_R2
+24V LED_B2
29 30
J588
CIS
GND(Frame)
ADF_SENS
FANLOCK
HP_SENS
RMOT_IA
RMOT_IB
KMOT_IA
KMOT_IB
SIZE_W1
SIZE_W2
RMOT_A
RMOT_A
RMOT_B
RMOT_B
KMOT_A
KMOT_A
KMOT_B
KMOT_B
RK_ON1
SIZE_L1
SIZE_L2
FANON
STAMP
EMPTY
LED_G1
LED_R1
LED_B1
CLK(+)
+3.3R
+3.3V
MODE
LAST
CLK(-)
+24V
+24V
EXIT
GND
GND
GND
GND
VREF
+3.3V
+3.3V
REG
Vout2
Vout1
Vout0
SP(+)
DES
+24V
SP(-)
F-9-221
9-101
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (250-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (5/7)
SIZE_SENS_ON
COVER_SENS0
RTP1BPWM
RTP1APWM
HP_SENS
SIDATAO
KMOT_IA
*KMOT_A
*KMOT_B
KMOT_IB
KMOT_A
KMOT_B
SIDATAI
SVCLK+
SILOAD
SVCLK-
EMPTY
DOUT7
DOUT6
DOUT5
DOUT4
DOUT3
DOUT2
DOUT1
DOUT0
*HSYNCI
*VSYNC
*RESET
*RTP1B
*RTP1A
STAMP
RTP1B
RTP1A
SICLK
EXIT
+5V
+3.3V
LAST
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
REG
DES
6 4
J559
1 2
3 2 1
2 1
J563
1 2 3 1 2 3 3
2 1 2 1 2 1
J557
1 2
S P
3 2
5 S 6 3
J563
2 P
J557
P 2
1 2
3 2
4 5
9-102
J8119
J9999
1 2
J2 USB
USB(H)
J8103
J112
VOUT2
1
1 2
VOUT1
B_PRDY B_CRDY C_PRDY C_CRDY GND COIN_TX COIN_RX GND VCC(5Vor3.3V) GND
9 10 11
GND
GND
J8146
3 2 1 1 2
J8127
J8147 J8134
6 5 4 3 2 1 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J8124
2 1
TX_OUT
SNOOP
HOOK1
CICNT_OUT
HOOK2
DCLIM
CAIDD
RX_IN
AGND
IPSEL
CMLD
LPRD
+3.3V
+12V
LPL1
LPL2
CIVS
GND
HRD
SRD
PRD
N.C.
N.C.
+5V
GND
GND
+24V
GND
+5V
CI1
CI2
GND
N.C.
J001
J002
J02
NCU PCB
VH(+) VH(-)
1
J4
FAX BOX
F-9-222
J004
Secondary Battery
J1
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
FFC
Mi2
(+)
(-)
11
13
15
17
19
21
Modular PCB
J0002
J9904
MODEM PCB
J8149
+5V
CCVI_CP_ENB
CCVI_KYU_COUNT
CCVI_CL_BW_L
CCVI_LARGE_SMALL_B
CCVI_OPTION
GND
J9901
+5V
CARD_READER_COUNT
J8103
J8104
J8110
J8111
CARD_READER_TX
USB(H)
USB(D)
SDcard
LAN
CARD_READER_RX
1 2 3 4 5
Card Reader
+24V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2
to Coin Vendor
J003
1 2 3
J3
Mi2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
9-102
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (250-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (6/7)
Contorol Panel
Touch Panel
1
TTP-L
P-GND K-DGT3 K-DGT4 K-DGT5 K-DGT6 K-DGT7 K-RTN1 K-RTN2 K-RTN3 K-RTN4 L-DGT3 L-DGT4 L-DGT5 L-RTN1 POWER-LED K-DGT0 K-DGT1 K-DGT2 K-RTN0 L-DGT0 L-DGT1 L-DGT2 L-RTN0 ESS-KEY VLCD -24VEE VLCG
TTP-D
3 4
TTP-R
TTP-U
1 2
J7 J6
1
J1
J5
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
J3
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
SOLDER
16 17 18 19 20 21 22
9 8 7 6 5 4
J955
SOLDER
Appendix > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (250-sheet 1st cassette type) > General Circuit Diagram (6/7)
J4
11
13
J1
FFC
10
12
14
F-9-223
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
23 24 25 26 27
3 2 1
LP
D0
D1
D2
D3
YD
+5R
1
+5R
N.C.
XSCL
VLCD
DOFF*
L-GND
-24VEE
-24VEE
BKLT_ON*
LCD
CCFL
2 3 4
9-103
9-103